US20120270939A1 - Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis - Google Patents

Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20120270939A1
US20120270939A1 US13/472,368 US201213472368A US2012270939A1 US 20120270939 A1 US20120270939 A1 US 20120270939A1 US 201213472368 A US201213472368 A US 201213472368A US 2012270939 A1 US2012270939 A1 US 2012270939A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
subject
mean
amyloidosis
compound
months
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US13/472,368
Inventor
Denis Garceau
Wendy Hauck
Richard Briand
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Kiacta Sarl
Original Assignee
Kiacta Sarl
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Kiacta Sarl filed Critical Kiacta Sarl
Priority to US13/472,368 priority Critical patent/US20120270939A1/en
Publication of US20120270939A1 publication Critical patent/US20120270939A1/en
Priority to US13/901,432 priority patent/US20130296434A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/185Acids; Anhydrides, halides or salts thereof, e.g. sulfur acids, imidic, hydrazonic or hydroximic acids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/16Amides, e.g. hydroxamic acids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/21Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates
    • A61K31/255Esters, e.g. nitroglycerine, selenocyanates of sulfoxy acids or sulfur analogues thereof
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/33Heterocyclic compounds
    • A61K31/395Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins
    • A61K31/495Heterocyclic compounds having nitrogen as a ring hetero atom, e.g. guanethidine or rifamycins having six-membered rings with two or more nitrogen atoms as the only ring heteroatoms, e.g. piperazine or tetrazines
    • A61K31/505Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim
    • A61K31/519Pyrimidines; Hydrogenated pyrimidines, e.g. trimethoprim ortho- or peri-condensed with heterocyclic rings
    • A61K31/525Isoalloxazines, e.g. riboflavins, vitamin B2
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K45/00Medicinal preparations containing active ingredients not provided for in groups A61K31/00 - A61K41/00
    • A61K45/06Mixtures of active ingredients without chemical characterisation, e.g. antiphlogistics and cardiaca
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P13/00Drugs for disorders of the urinary system
    • A61P13/12Drugs for disorders of the urinary system of the kidneys
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/28Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating neurodegenerative disorders of the central nervous system, e.g. nootropic agents, cognition enhancers, drugs for treating Alzheimer's disease or other forms of dementia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P29/00Non-central analgesic, antipyretic or antiinflammatory agents, e.g. antirheumatic agents; Non-steroidal antiinflammatory drugs [NSAID]
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00

Definitions

  • Amyloidosis is the generic term for a number of diseases related by extracellular deposition of insoluble fibrillar proteins (amyloid) in specific organs, which eventually leads to the failure of the involved organs.
  • R. H. Falk et al The Systemic Amyloidosis, 337 N ENGL J MED 898-909 (1997), P. N. Hawkins, Amyloidosis, 9 BLOOD REV 135-42 (1995), J. D. Sipe, Amyloidosis, 31 CR REV CE1N LAB SC 1325-54 (1994); A. S. Cohen, Amyloidosis, 40(2) BULL RHEUM DISEASES 1-12 (1991).
  • Amyloid deposits can remain limited to one organ (localized amyloidosis) or may be more broadly distributed (systemic amyloidosis).
  • Systemic amyloidoses are generally classified into four types based on the nature of the fibrillar deposits: (i.) idiopathic or primary amyloidosis (AL amyloidosis); (ii.) reactive, secondary or amyloid A (AA) amyloidosis; (iii.) familial amyloidotic polyneuropathy; and (iv.) dialysis-associated amyloidosis.
  • amyloid deposits have common morphologic properties, stain with specific dyes (e.g., Congo red), and have a characteristic birefringent appearance in polarized light after staining. They also share common ultrastructural features and common X-ray diffraction and infrared spectra.
  • specific dyes e.g., Congo red
  • AA amyloidosis is thought to be related to amyloid A (AA) protein formed from the precursor serum amyloid A (SAA), an acute phase protein produced and secreted by hepatocytes in response to inflammation.
  • AA amyloidosis is associated with chronic inflammatory conditions (e.g. rheumatoid arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, inflammatory bowel disease, etc.), chronic infections (e.g., tuberculosis, osteomyelitis etc.), and hereditary fevers, e.g., Familial Mediterranean Fever (R. H. Falk et al., 337 N ENGL J MED 898-909 (1997), A. S.
  • AA amyloidosis mainly affects parenchymatous organs, such as, kidneys, spleen, liver, and adrenals.
  • the most common clinical feature of AA amyloidosis is renal dysfunction manifested as nephrotic-range proteinuria or renal insufficiency at the time of diagnosis.
  • End-stage renal failure is the cause of death in 40-60% of cases (M. Skinner Amyloidosis , C URRENT T HERAPY IN A LLERGY , I MMUNOLOGY, AND R HEUMATOLOGY 235-40 (Mosby-Year Book Inc., 1996), M. A. Gertz, 232 J INT MED 517-18 (1992), M. A. Gertz and R. A.
  • Gastrointestinal involvement is also frequent and is usually manifested as chronic diarrhea, body weight loss and malabsorption. Enlargement of the liver and spleen may also occur in some subjects. Cardiac involvement is rare and occurs late in the disease. The median survival time from diagnosis varies from 2 to 8 years depending on the stage of the disease at time of diagnosis (M. A. Gertz and R. A. Kyle, 70 M EDICINE 246-256 (1991)).
  • AA amyloidosis is usually seen associated with chronic infection (such as tuberculosis) or chronic inflammation (such as rheumatoid arthritis or hereditary fevers).
  • chronic infection such as tuberculosis
  • chronic inflammation such as rheumatoid arthritis or hereditary fevers.
  • a familial form of AA amyloidosis is seen Familial Mediterranean Fever (FMF). This familial type of amyloidosis is genetically inherited and is found in specific population groups. In both AL and AA amyloidosis, deposits are found in several organs and are thus considered systemic amyloid diseases.
  • FMF Familial Mediterranean Fever
  • “Localized amyloidoses” are those that tend to involve a single organ system. Different amyloids are also characterized by the type of protein present in the deposit. For example, neurodegenerative diseases such as scrapie, bovine spongiform encephalitis, Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease, and the like are characterized by the appearance and accumulation of a protease-resistant form of a prion protein (referred to as AScr or PrP-27) in the central nervous system. Similarly, Alzheimer's disease, another neurodegenerative disorder, is characterized by neuritic plaques and neurofibrillary tangles.
  • amyloid plaques found in the parenchyma and the blood vessel is formed by the deposition of fibrillar A ⁇ amyloid protein.
  • Other diseases such as adult-onset diabetes (type II diabetes) are characterized by the localized accumulation of amyloid fibrils in the pancreas.
  • amyloids have formed, there is no known, widely accepted therapy or treatment which significantly dissolves amyloid deposits in situ, prevents further amyloid deposition or prevents the initiation of amyloid deposition.
  • Each amyloidogenic protein has the ability to undergo a conformational change and to organize into ⁇ -sheets and form insoluble fibrils which may be deposited extracellularly or intracellularly.
  • Each amyloidogenic protein although different in amino acid sequence, has the same property of forming fibrils and binding to other elements such as proteoglycan, amyloid P and complement component.
  • each amyloidogenic protein has amino acid sequences which, although different, show similarities such as regions with the ability to bind to the glycosaminoglycan (GAG) portion of proteoglycan (referred to as the GAG binding site) as well as other regions which promote ⁇ -sheet formation.
  • GAG glycosaminoglycan
  • Proteoglycans are macromolecules of various sizes and structures that are distributed almost everywhere in the body.
  • GAGs polysaccharide chains
  • GAG mimetics are known to be useful for inhibiting amyloid deposition and/or treating some forms of amyloidosis. See WO 94/22437, WO 96/28187, and WO 00/64420.
  • the invention pertains to a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a target subject, by administering to the target subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the formula:
  • Y is SO 3 X or OSO 3 X independently chosen for each occurrence; X is cationic group independently chosen for each occurrence; n is 1, 2, 3 or 4; and m is 1 or 2, such that the AA amyloidosis is treated or prevented, while maintaining an acceptable tolerance index (ATI) for a parameter associated with renal impairment (PRI).
  • ATI acceptable tolerance index
  • PRI renal impairment
  • the target subject is being treated for AA amyloidosis and has or is susceptible to a parameter associated with renal impairment.
  • the compound of formula (I) is 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt.
  • the invention includes a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a target subject, by administering to the target subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the AA amyloidosis is treated or prevented while maintaining an acceptable tolerance index (ATI) for a parameter associated with gastrointestinal impairment (PGI).
  • ATI acceptable tolerance index
  • PKI gastrointestinal impairment
  • the target subject is being treated for AA amyloidosis and has or is susceptible to a parameter associated with gastrointestinal impairment.
  • the invention also pertains to a method of treating or preventing an amyloid related disease in a subject by administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, at a dosage selected based upon creatinine clearance rate, such that the amyloid related disease is treated or prevented.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method for treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a subject, by administering to the subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, which is administered in a dosage, such that an effective exposure is provided in a subject, for example, as measured by, e.g., AUC, C max , AUC ss , C ss , T max , etc.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention also pertains to a method of stabilizing or improving renal and/or gastrointestinal function in a subject.
  • the method includes administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt.
  • the invention in another embodiment, pertains to a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a subject.
  • the method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent such that AA amyloidosis is treated or prevented.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of increasing the oral bioavailability of a compound in a subject, by administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in a pharmaceutical composition without food such that the oral bioavailability of the compound in the subject is increased.
  • a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating an inflammatory disease in a subject, by administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent such that said inflammatory disease is treated in the subject.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating a hereditary fever in a subject, by administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent such that said hereditary fever is treated in the subject.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method for treating rheumatoid arthritis in a subject.
  • the method includes administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention also includes a method of treating a malignant neoplasm in a subject.
  • the method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent such that the malignant neoplasm is treated in the subject.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating a chronic infection, e.g., microbial or viral, in a subject.
  • the method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent such that the chronic infection is treated in the subject.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains at least in part to method of stabilizing or improving renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having an inflammatory disorder, a malignant neoplasm, a chronic infection or a hereditary fever.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, such that renal function is stabilized or improved or progression of renal disease is delayed.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for preventing or delaying progression to ESRD/dialysis in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject, e.g., a subject having AA amyloidosis, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that progression to ESRD/dialysis is delayed or prevented.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for preventing or delaying the time to the doubling of serum creatinine in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound, of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the time to the doubling of serum creatinine is delayed or prevented.
  • a compound, of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for preventing or delaying the time to at least a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the time to the at least a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is delayed or prevented.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for decreasing the time to at least a 50% increase in creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the time to the at least 50% increase in creatinine clearance is decreased.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention includes a method for reducing the rate of progression of renal disease as measured by the slope of creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the rate of progression of renal disease is reduced.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for stabilizing or reducing proteinuria in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the proteinuria in said subject is stabilized or reduced.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention includes a method for stabilizing renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that renal function is stabilized or progression of renal disease is delayed.
  • progression of renal disease may be measured by a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance (CrCI), doubling of serum creatinine (SCr), and/or progression to ESRD.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for treating renal impairment in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the renal impairment is treated.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical composition
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, and a second agent.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition.
  • the packaged pharmaceutical composition includes a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, packaged in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered in combination with a second agent.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition, which includes a therapeutically effective amount of a second agent packaged in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered in combination with a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt.
  • the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition, which includes a container holding a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered without food.
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation for treating AA amyloidosis.
  • the formulation comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in a formulation, wherein the formulation has at least one favorable biological property (FBP) upon administration to the subject.
  • a compound of formula (I) e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to an anti-amyloidogenic agent in a formulation, wherein the anti-amyloidogenic agent-containing formulation is equivalent to a standard formulation predetermined to have at least one favorable biological property upon administration to a subject such that it is a biologically favorable formulation.
  • the invention also includes a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprising a compound of formula (I), and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers.
  • the pharmaceutical formulation when administered once to a subject in need thereof, provides a C max of about 200 to about 2000 ng/mL.
  • the invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising a compound of formula (I), and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers.
  • the pharmaceutical formulation when administered to a subject in need thereof, provides an AUC ⁇ about 2,000 to about 44,000 ng/mL.
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method of administering a compound to a subject in need thereof.
  • the method includes administering a compound of formula (I) to the subject in an amount sufficient to achieve a C max of about 200 to about 3,400 ng/mL.
  • the C max may occur about 0.25 to about 9.00 hours after administration.
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method of administering a compound of formula (I) to a subject in need thereof.
  • the method includes administering a compound of formula (I) to the subject in an amount sufficient to achieve an AUC ⁇ of about 2,000 to about 44,000 ng/mL.
  • the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises a 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers.
  • the pharmaceutical formulation provides a C max of about 200 to about 2000 ng/mL, when administered once to a subject in need thereof.
  • the invention also includes a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers.
  • the pharmaceutical formulation provides a AUC ⁇ of about 2,000 to about 44,000 ng/mL, when administered to a subject in need thereof.
  • the invention also pertains to a method of administering 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof to a subject in need thereof.
  • the method includes administering 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof to a subject in an amount sufficient to achieve a C max of about 200 to about 3,400 ng/mL about 0.25 to about 9.00 hours after administration.
  • the invention also pertains to a method of administering 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof to a subject in need thereof, by administering 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof to the subject in an amount sufficient to achieve an AUC ⁇ of about 2,000 to about 44,000 ng/mL.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation.
  • the pharmaceutical formulation comprises an active agent (e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid, disodium salt (also referred to as PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about from 2900 to about 9000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20% and a mean C max of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • an active agent e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid, disodium salt (also referred to as PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis
  • PDS disodium salt
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of from about 2,900 to about 9,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • an active agent e.g., PDS
  • the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean C max of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • an active agent e.g., PDS
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean C max of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of less than about 30 ml/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 10,000-12,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 800-900 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of about 30 to about 80 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 9,000-10,500 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C ma , of about 750-875 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or
  • an active agent
  • the invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising 800 mgs of an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject: when said subject is healthy, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 4,000-6,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 1,200-1,300 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the subject has mild renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 12,000-14,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 2,500-3,500 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the subject has moderate renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 9,000-11,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 2,000-2,200 ng/mL ⁇ 2
  • an active agent
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis for twenty-four months: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 25,000-26,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 2,000-2,300 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 20,000-22,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 1,600-2,000 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1200 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 8,000-10,000
  • an active agent
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to healthy male subjects for seven days: in a dose of 400 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 10,000-11,500 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 900-1100 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 19,000-21,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 1,600-1,800 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1600 mg TID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 25,000-27,000 ng ⁇ h/mL
  • an active agent
  • the invention also pertains to a method of stabilizing or improving renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes orally administering a formulation comprising 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, in an amount determined in accordance with the subject's rate of creatinine clearance.
  • a mean plasma concentration profile of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 10,000-12,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 800-900 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 800 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 9,000-10,500 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max about 750-875 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 1200 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 5,000-6,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 800-925 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • a pharmaceutical formulation which comprises an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • this formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of less than about 30 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 6,000-17,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 500-1200 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of from about 30 to about 80 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method of stabilizing or improving renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having AA amyloidosis, comprising orally administering a formulation comprising 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, in an amount determined in accordance with the subject's rate of creatinine clearance.
  • a mean plasma concentration profile of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 6,000-17,000 ng ⁇ h/mL 20%, and a mean C max of about 500-1200 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 800 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 3000-20000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 300-1200 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 1200 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 2,000-11,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 400-1500 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • FIG. 1 is a graph depicting a Kaplan-Meier curve for the time to the first “worse” event for subjects administered PDS versus a placebo.
  • FIG. 2 is a line graph showing the slope of creatinine clearance for subjects administered PDS versus a placebo.
  • FIG. 3 is a graph depicting a Kaplan-Meier curve for the time to a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance for subjects administered PDS versus a placebo.
  • FIG. 4 is a graph depicting a Kaplan-Meier curve for the time to ESRD/Dialysis for subjects administered PDS versus a placebo.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a target subject who is being treated for AA amyloidosis and has or is susceptible to a parameter associated with renal impairment.
  • the method includes administering to the target subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the formula:
  • Y is SO 3 X or OSO 3 X independently chosen for each occurrence; X is cationic group independently chosen for each occurrence; n is 1, 2, 3 or 4; and m is 1 or 2, such that AA amyloidosis is treated or prevented while maintaining an acceptable tolerance index (ATI) for a parameter associated with renal impairment (PRI).
  • ATI acceptable tolerance index
  • the invention includes a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a target subject, who is being treated for AA amyloidosis and has or is susceptible to a secondary disorder or state associated with gastrointestinal impairment.
  • the method includes administering to the target subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), while maintaining an acceptable tolerance index (All) for a parameter associated with gastrointestinal impairment (PGI).
  • AA amyloidosis is a manifestation of a number of diseases that provoke a sustained acute phase response. Such diseases include chronic inflammatory disorders, chronic local or systemic microbial infections, and malignant neoplasms. The most common form of reactive or secondary (AA) amyloidosis is seen as the result of long-standing inflammatory conditions. For example, subjects with Rheumatoid Arthritis or Familial Mediterranean Fever (which is a genetic disease) can develop AA amyloidosis.
  • Rheumatoid Arthritis or Familial Mediterranean Fever which is a genetic disease
  • Familial Mediterranean Fever which is a genetic disease
  • AA fibrils are generally composed of 8,000 Dalton fragments (AA peptide or protein) formed by proteolytic cleavage of serum amyloid A protein (ApoSAA), a circulating apolipoprotein which is mainly synthesized in hepatocytes in response to such cytokines as IL-1, IL-6 and TNF. Once secreted, ApoSAA is complexed with HDL. Deposition of AA fibrils can be widespread in the body, with a preference for parenchymal organs. The kidneys are usually a deposition site, and the liver and the spleen may also be affected. Deposition is also seen in the heart, gastrointestinal tract, and the skin.
  • ApoSAA serum amyloid A protein
  • Underlying diseases which can lead to the development of AA amyloidosis include, but are not limited to, inflammatory diseases, such as chronic inflammatory disease, rheumatoid arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriasis, psoriatic arthropathy, Reiter's syndrome, Adult Still's disease, Behcet's syndrome, familial Mediterranean fever, inflammatory bowel disease, hereditary periodic fevers, juvenile chronic arthritis, juvenile rheumatoid arthritis, ulcerative colitis, chronic fevers, bronchiostasis, malaria, vasculitis, IV drug use, psoriatic arthritis, lupus erythematosus arthritis, periarthritis nodosa, Wegner's granulomatosis, Muckle-Wells syndrome and Crohn's disease.
  • inflammatory diseases such as chronic inflammatory disease, rheumatoid arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriasis, p
  • AA deposits are also produced as a result of chronic infections, e.g., AIDS, HIV, hepatitis B, hepatitis C, chronic microbial infections, e.g., leprosy, tuberculosis, bronchiectasis, decubitus ulcers, pyelonephritis, osteomyelitis, acne conglobata, common variable immunodeficiency, hypolagammaglobulinemia, cystic fibrosis, pulmonary tuberculosis, pulmonary infection(s), recurrent abscesses, Behcet's disease, and Whipple's disease. Certain malignant neoplasms can also result in AA fibril amyloid deposits.
  • chronic infections e.g., AIDS, HIV, hepatitis B, hepatitis C
  • chronic microbial infections e.g., leprosy, tuberculosis, bronchiectasis, decubitus ulcers
  • subject includes living organisms in which AA amyloidosis or an amyloid related disease can occur, or which are susceptible to AA amyloidosis or amyloid related diseases.
  • subject includes animals (e.g., mammals, e.g., cats, dogs, horses, pigs, cows, goats, sheep, rodents, e.g., mice or rats, rabbits, squirrels, bears, primates (e.g., chimpanzees, monkeys, gorillas, and humans)), as well as chickens, ducks, peking ducks, geese, and transgenic species thereof.
  • animals e.g., mammals, e.g., cats, dogs, horses, pigs, cows, goats, sheep, rodents, e.g., mice or rats, rabbits, squirrels, bears, primates (e.g., chimpanzees, monkeys, gorillas, and humans)
  • primates e.g., chimpanzee
  • target subject refers to a subject, e.g., a human, specifically chosen to receive the compositions or compounds of formula (I).
  • target subjects include subjects who are at risk of or have been diagnosed with an AA amyloid related disease, e.g., AA amyloidosis.
  • Subjects at risk of developing AA amyloidosis include those with an underlying disease, such as an inflammatory disease, infection, hereditary fever or neoplasm.
  • target subjects include subjects that have or are susceptible to a parameter associated with renal impairment and/or gastrointestinal impairment.
  • Target subjects also may include subjects who have been diagnosed with both an AA amyloid related disease and are known to have a parameter associated with renal impairment and/or gastrointestinal impairment.
  • the preferred target subject is a human.
  • an ATI is used interchangeably to refer to a level of illness in a subject that is considered satisfactory at a given time point in the disease or disorder afflicting the subject.
  • an ATI is an improvement or stabilization of the illness in a subject, as described herein.
  • an ATI is less worsening of an illness in a subject, as compared to a previous time point, e.g., when a subject is experiencing a rapid increase in serum creatinine levels, an ATI may be a slower increase in serum creatinine levels.
  • an ATI is less worsening in a subject of at least one of the parameters associated with renal impairment or gastrointestinal impairment.
  • an ATI is less worsening in a subject of at least two of the parameters associated with renal impairment and/or gastrointestinal impairment. In still another embodiment, an ATI is less worsening in a subject of at least three, four or five of the parameters associated with renal impairment and/or gastrointestinal impairment.
  • parameter associated with renal impairment and “PRI” are used interchangeably to include parameters generally associated with abnormal kidney function, such as, but not limited to decreased creatinine clearance, increased levels of serum creatinine, proteinuria, progression to dialysis/End Stage Renal Disease (ESRD), hypoalbuminemia, and/or edema.
  • the parameter associated with renal impairment is caused, at least in part, by AA amyloidosis or the presence of amyloid A protein in the body.
  • parameter associated with gastrointestinal impairment include parameters generally associated with abnormal gastrointestinal function, such as, but not limited to, chronic diarrhea and/or loss of body weight.
  • the parameter associated with gastrointestinal impairment is caused, at least in part, by AA amyloidosis or the presence of amyloid A protein in the body.
  • treatment includes the application or administration of a compound of the invention to a subject (or application or administration of a compound of the invention to a cell or tissue from a subject) with the purpose of stabilizing, curing, healing, alleviating, relieving, altering, remedying, less worsening, ameliorating, improving, or affecting the disease or condition, the symptom of the disease or condition, or the risk of (or susceptibility to) the disease or condition.
  • treating refers to any indicia of success in the treatment or amelioration of an injury, pathology or condition, including any objective or subjective parameter such as abatement; remission; lessening of the rate of worsening; stabilization, diminishing of symptoms or making the injury, pathology or condition more tolerable to the subject; slowing in the rate of degeneration or decline; making the final point of degeneration less debilitating; or improving a subject's physical or mental well-being.
  • the term “treating” can include increasing a subject's life expectancy.
  • the term “remission of chronic diarrhea” refers to no episodes of chronic diarrhea and no chronic use of antidiarrheal agents for at least four consecutive months.
  • the progression to dialysis is delayed or prevented in a subject, e.g., a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • a subject's progression to dialysis may be delayed by 1 month or longer, 2 months or longer, 3 months or longer, 4 months or longer, 5 months or longer, 6 months or longer, 7 months or longer, 8 months or longer, 10 months or longer, 11 months or longer, 1 year or longer, 1.5 years or longer, 2 years or longer, 3 years or longer, 4 years or longer, 5 years or longer, 7.5 years or longer, 10 years or longer, 15 years or longer, or 20 years or longer. In a particular embodiment, it is delayed by about 6 months.
  • the term “treating” includes decreasing the risk of any “worse” event of renal decline (see Example 3) or all-cause mortality by at least 5% or greater, at least 10% or greater, at least 15% or greater, at least 20% or greater, at least 30% or greater, at least 40% or greater, at least 50% or greater, at least 60% or greater, or at least 63% or greater.
  • the risk of any “worse” event of renal decline or all-cause mortality is decreased 7%-63%.
  • the term “treating” also includes increasing the mean time to the first “worse” event.
  • the increase may be about 0.5 months or longer, about 1 month or longer, about 2 months or longer, about 3 months or longer, about 4 months or longer, about 5 months or longer, about 6 months or longer, about 7 months or longer, about 8 months or longer, about 9 months or longer, about 10 months or longer, or about 11 months or longer.
  • the time is increased by about: 2.8 months ⁇ 7.5 months longer in PDS treated subjects.
  • the subject's creatinine clearance rate is stabilized or improved.
  • a subject's creatinine clearance rate may be increased by about 10% or greater, by about 20% or greater, by about 30% or greater, by about 40% or greater, by about 50% or greater, by about 60% or greater, by about 70% or greater, by about 80% or greater, by about 90% or greater, or by about 100% or greater as compared to the subject's level prior to treatment with the compounds of the invention.
  • the risk of a 50% or greater decrease in creatinine clearance is reduced at least about 5% or more, at least about 10% or more, at least about 15% or more, or at least about 18% or more. In a further embodiment, the risk of a 50% or greater decrease in creatinine clearance is reduced about 18% to 72%.
  • a subject's serum creatinine, serum albumin levels, and/or serum alkaline phosphatase levels are stabilized or improved.
  • a subject's serum creatinine, serum albumin levels, and/or serum alkaline phosphatase levels may be increased by about 10% or greater, by about 20% or greater, by about 30% or greater, by about 40% or greater, by about 50% or greater, by about 60% or greater, by about 70% or greater, by about 80% or greater, by about 90% or greater, or by about 100% or greater as compared to the subject's level prior to treatment with the compounds of the invention.
  • the risk of the doubling of serum creatinine is reduced by at least 5% or greater, at least 10% or greater, at least 11% or greater, at least 12% or greater, at least 13% or greater, or at least 14% or greater. In a further embodiment, a subject's risk of having their serum creatinine is double is reduced from about 14% to about 81%.
  • the term “treating” also includes increasing the mean time to the doubling of serum creatinine.
  • the increase may be about 0.5 months or longer, about 1 month or longer, about 2 months or longer, about 3 months or longer, about 4 months or longer, about 5 months or longer, about 6 months or longer, about 7 months or longer, about 8 months or longer, about 9 months or longer, about 10 months or longer, about 11 months or longer, or about a year or longer.
  • a subject's proteinuria levels, visceral amyloid burden, and/or amyloid content in aspirated fat tissue are stabilized or improved.
  • a subject's proteinuria levels, visceral amyloid burden, and/or amyloid content in aspirated fat tissue may be reduced by about 10% or greater, by about 20% or greater, by about 30% or greater, by about 40% or greater, by about 50% or greater, by about 60% or greater, by about 70% or greater, by about 80% or greater, by about 90% or greater, or by about 100% or greater as compared to the subject's level prior to treatment with the compounds of the invention.
  • a subject's visceral amyloid burden is reduced or stabilized.
  • a subject's visceral amyloid burden can be assessed by, for example, using 123 I-radiolabeled serum amyloid P component (SAP) scintigraphy.
  • SAP serum amyloid P component
  • Scintigraphic imaging with radiolabeled SAP has been developed as a specific noninvasive method for assessing visceral amyloid burden (Hawkins P N et al. N Engl J Med, 1990; 323:508-13).
  • Visceral amyloid burden can be quantified, for example, by visual assessment of whole body scintigraphs obtained 24 hours after the injection of the radionuclide.
  • a subject's amyloid content in aspirated fat tissue is reduced or stabilized.
  • amyloid content in aspirated fat tissue refers to the content of amyloid A in aspirated fat tissue. Changes in amyloid A content in aspirated fat tissue can be measured semi-quantitatively by Congo red staining. Amyloid A content in fat tissue can be measured quantitatively, for example, by using a monoclonal antibody-based sandwich ELISA using fat tissue collected from a subject. (Hazenberg B et al. Ann Rheum Dis, 1999; 58: 96-102).
  • orthostatic hypotension refers to a sudden fall in blood pressure that occurs when a person assumes a standing position. Symptoms, which generally occur after sudden standing, include dizziness, lightheadedness, blurred vision, and syncope (temporary loss of consciousness).
  • the autonomic nervous system (ANS) is sometimes affected in AA amyloidosis.
  • a postural decrease in blood pressure e.g. a drop from the supine to standing position of 20 mmHg in systolic blood pressure or 10 mmHg in diastolic blood pressure sustained for at least 3 min) is a sign of ANS dysfunction.
  • a subject's body weight loss is improved or stabilized, or the subject gains weight.
  • a subject might gain 5% or more, about 10% or more, about 20% or more, about 30% or more, about 40% or more, about 50% or more, or about 60% or more of their body weight prior to treatment with the compounds of the invention.
  • a subject's nephrotic syndrome may be stabilized or go into remission.
  • a subject's edema may be resolved or alleviated.
  • the stabilization, improvement, cure, or remission of diarrhea in a subject may occur.
  • remission of nephrotic syndrome includes a decrease in proteinuria to ⁇ 1 g/24 h and either an increase in serum albumin to greater than 3.4 g/dL or resolution of an edema and/or discontinuation of diuretics in response to improvement in edema.
  • terapéuticaally effective amount refers to the amount of a compound which is effective to treat a subject, e.g., treat a subject for AA amyloidosis or an amyloid related disease or treat a subject having an underlying disease, such as, but not limited to, an inflammatory disorder, a malignant neoplasm, or chronic microbial infection.
  • the therapeutically effective amount may vary based on the particular disorder(s) the subject is suffering from, the age, weight, and lifestyle of a particular subject.
  • the therapeutically effective amount may depend on the seventy of the disease state, organ function, kidney function, or underlying disease (e.g., the subject may be suffering from an inflammatory disease, a malignant neoplasm, a chronic infection).
  • the subject is nephrotic.
  • the subject is non-nephrotic.
  • Nephrotic refers to a subject suffering from nephrotic syndrome.
  • Nephrotic syndrome is generally defined as heavy proteinuria (e.g., urinary protein >3 g/24 h) in combination with the two following extrarenal features 1) hypoalbuminemia (e.g., serum albumin ⁇ 3.4 g/dL); and 2) a peripheral edema by physical examination and/or use of diuretics to treat edema.
  • heavy proteinuria e.g., urinary protein >3 g/24 h
  • hypoalbuminemia e.g., serum albumin ⁇ 3.4 g/dL
  • diuretics edema by physical examination and/or use of diuretics to treat edema.
  • non-nephrotic refers to a subject who has not yet progressed to nephrotic syndrome or who is in remission of nephrotic syndrome.
  • Remission of nephrotic syndrome is a decrease in proteinuria to ⁇ 1 g/24 h and an improvement in one of the two following extrarenal features: 1) increase in serum albumin to 3.4 g/dL or 2) resolution of edema and/or discontinuation of diuretics in response to improvement in edema.
  • Progression to nephrotic syndrome is an increase in proteinuria to >3 g/24 h and occurrence of the two following extrarenal features: 1) hypoalbuminemia (serum albumin ⁇ 3.4 g/dL) and 2) edema and/or use of diuretics to treat edema.
  • the invention also pertains to a method of treating or preventing amyloid related disease in a subject by administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) at a dosage selected based upon the subject's creatinine clearance rate, proteinuria level, and/or serum albumin levels.
  • Creatinine clearance is art recognized and refers to the rate at which the kidneys clear creatinine from the blood. Creatinine is a substance that is easily excreted by the kidney in healthy subjects. Creatinine clearance generally compares the level of creatinine in urine with the creatinine level in the blood. Clearance is often measured as milliliters/minute (ml/min).
  • the dosage administered in the methods of the present invention may be selected based upon creatinine clearance rate.
  • the dosage of the compound of formula (I) may be selected to be about 1200 mg twice daily for a creatinine clearance rate of >80 mL/min.
  • the dosage of the compound of formula (I) may be selected to be about 800 mg twice daily.
  • the dosage of the compound of formula (I) may be selected to be about 400 mg twice daily.
  • the dosage also may be adjusted based on the changing creatinine clearance rates in the subject.
  • the dosage may be selected such that desired pharmacokinetic parameters and/or biologically favorable parameters are obtained after administration of the compound of the invention to the subject.
  • the dosage is selected such that once administered to the subject, the mean AUC ss in the subject is about 7,000 to about 26,000 ng ⁇ h/mL and the mean steady state concentration is about 500 to about 1200 ng/mL.
  • the dosage is selected such that once administered to the subject, the C max in the subject is about 1,200 to about 3,100 ng/mL and the AUC ⁇ is about 5,000 to about 43,000 ng ⁇ h/mL.
  • the dosages needed to achieve a particular AUC ss , AUC ⁇ , C max , and steady state mean concentration may need to be adjusted.
  • the C max , AUC 0-tlast , and/or AUC ⁇ may vary for a particular subject by about ⁇ 10%, by about ⁇ 20%, by about ⁇ 30%, or by about ⁇ 40% as compared to the values shown in Table 1.
  • amyloid-related disease refers to a pathological condition characterized by the presence of amyloid fibers.
  • Amyloid is a generic term referring to a group of diverse but specific protein deposits (intracellular or extracellular) which are seen in a number of different diseases. Though diverse in their occurrence, all amyloid deposits have common morphologic properties, stain with specific dyes (e.g., Congo red), and have a characteristic red-green birefringent appearance in polarized light after staining. They also share common ultrastructural features and common X-ray diffraction and infrared spectra.
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to another method for treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a subject.
  • This method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), which is administered in a dosage such that an effective systemic exposure is provided in a subject, for example, as measured by, e.g., AUC, C max , AUC ss , C ss , T max , etc.
  • target plasma concentration refers to a range of concentrations in the subject of the compound of the invention which result in treatment of the subject for AA amyloidosis.
  • the subject maintains a steady state concentration (C ss ) of about 500 to about 1200 ng/mL.
  • the subject maintains an AUC ss from about 7000 to about 26,000 ng ⁇ h/mL.
  • the subject may maintain a steady state concentration of about 600 to about 700 ng/mL, or about 900 to about 1100 ng/mL and/or an AUC ⁇ of about 8000 to about 9000 ng ⁇ h/mL, or about 11,000 to about 13,000 ng ⁇ h/mL, or about 23,000 to about 26,000 ng ⁇ h/mL, or about 15,500 to about 16,500 ng ⁇ h/mL.
  • the AUC ss or the steady state concentration are within ⁇ 20% of these values.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of stabilizing or improving renal and/or gastrointestinal function in a subject.
  • the method includes administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I).
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation.
  • the formulation comprises an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about from 2900 to about 9000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20% and a mean C max of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of from about 2,900 to about 9,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean C max of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • the invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • a pharmaceutical formulation which comprises an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 10,000-12,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 800-900 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of from about 30 to about 80 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 9,000-10,500 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 750-875 ng/mL ⁇
  • this invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising 800 mgs of an active agent, which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • this formulation when this formulation is orally administered to a subject: when the subject is healthy, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 4,000-6,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 1,200-1,300 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the subject has mild renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 12,000-14,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 2,500-3,500 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the subject has moderate renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 9,000-11,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about
  • the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • this formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis for twenty-four months: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 25,000-26,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 2,000-2,300 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 20,000-22,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 1,600-2,000 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1200 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about
  • the invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • a pharmaceutical formulation comprising an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • this formulation when this formulation is orally administered to healthy male subjects for seven days: in a dose of 400 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 10,000-11,500 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 900-1100 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 19,000-21,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 1,600-1,800 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in
  • the invention also pertains to a method of stabilizing or improving renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes orally administering a formulation comprising 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, in an amount determined in accordance with the subject's rate of creatinine clearance.
  • a mean plasma concentration profile of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 10,000-12,000 ng ⁇ h/mL 20%, and a mean C max of about 800-900 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 800 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 9,000-10,500 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 750-875 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 1200 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 5,000-6,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 800-925 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • the dose is 400 mg when the subject's rate of creatinine clearance is less than about 30 mL/min, the dose is 800 mg when the subject's rate of creatinine clearance is from about 30 to about 80 ml/min, and the dose is 1200 mg when the subject's rate of creatinine clearance is greater than about 80 mL/min.
  • the subject's rate of creatinine clearance is about 60 to about 90 mL/min and a dose of 1200 mg is administered.
  • the invention in another embodiment, pertains to a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a subject.
  • the method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a second agent, such that AA amyloidosis is treated or prevented.
  • the term “in combination with” refers to the concurrent administration of a compound of formula (I) and a second agent; the administration of the compound of formula (I) prior to the administration of the second agent; or administration of the second agent prior to administration of the compound of formula (I).
  • second agent includes drugs known to treat underlying diseases, e.g., inflammatory diseases (e.g., chronic inflammatory disease, rheumatoid arthritis, juvenile chronic arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriasis, psoriatic arthropathy, Reiter's syndrome, psoriatic arthritis, lupus erythematosus arthritis, periarthritis nodosa, Wegner's granulomatosis, Muckle-Wells syndrome, Adult Still's disease, Behcet's syndrome, familial Mediterranean fever, inflammatory bowel disease, hereditary periodic fevers, and Crohn's disease, etc.), diseases associated with chronic infections (e.g., AIDS, HIV, hepatitis B, hepatitis C, etc.), diseases associated with chronic microbial infections (e.g., leprosy, tuberculosis, bronchiectasis, decubitus ulcers, pyelone
  • second agent also includes rescue agents, chemotherapeutic agents, anti-inflammatory agents, e.g., non-steroidal anti-inflammatory agents, etc., and antibiotics.
  • second agents include methotrexate, colchicine, anti-TNF antibodies and anti-interleukin 1 or 6 antibodies.
  • nonsteroidal anti-inflammatory agents include ibuprofen, naproxen, sulindac, and indomethacin.
  • Other anti-inflammatory agents include COX-2 inhibitors (such as VioxxTM and CelebrexTM), cytokine inhibitors (such as thalidomide disclosed in WO 95/04533 and dexanabinol) complement inhibitors, leukotriene receptor antagonists and combinations thereof.
  • Examples include acetic acid derivatives sulindac (ClinorilTM, Merck & Co., Inc., Rahway, N.J.), indomethacin (IndocinTM, Merck & Co., Inc., Rahway, N.J.); etodolac (LodineTM, Wyeth, Madison, N.J.), nabumetone (RelafenTM, GlaxoSmithKline, Middlesex, England), tolmetin sodium (TolectinTM, McNeil Pharmaceuticals, Spring House, Pa.); anthranilic acid derivatives: meclofenamate sodium (MeclomenTM, Pfizer, New York, N.Y.), mefenamic acid (PonstelTM, Pfizer, New York, N.Y.); enolic acid derivatives: piroxicam (FeldeneTM, Pfizer, New York, N.Y.), MobicTM (meloxicam); phenylacetic acid derivatives: arthrotec (dicl
  • chemotherapeutic agent includes agents which inhibit the growth of proliferating cells or tissues wherein the growth of such cells or tissues is undesirable or otherwise treat at least one resulting symptom of such a growth.
  • chemotherapeutic agents include: bleomycin, docetaxel (Taxotere), doxorubicin, edatrexate, etoposide, finasteride (Proscar), flutamide (Eulexin), gemcitabine (Gemzar), goserelin acetate (Zoladex), granisetron (Kytril), irinotecan (Campto/Camptosar), ondansetron (Zofran), paclitaxel (Taxol), pegaspargase (Oncaspar), pilocarpine hydrochloride (Salagen), porfimer sodium (Photofrin), interleukin-2 (Proleukin), rituximab (Rituxan), topotecan (Hycamt
  • chemotherapeutic agents include alkylating drugs such as nitrogen mustards (e.g., mechlorethamine (HN 2 ), cyclophosphamide, ifosfamide, Melphalan (L-sarcolysin), Chlorambucil, etc.); ethylenimines, methylmelamines (e.g., hexamethylmelamine, thiotepa, etc.), alkyl sulfonates (e.g., busulfan, etc.), nitrosoureas (e.g., carmustine (BCNU), lomustine (CCNU), semustine (methyl-CCNU), streptozocin (streptozotocin), etc.), triazenes (e.g., decarbazine (DTIC; dimethyltriazenoimidazolecarboxamide)), alkylators (e.g., cis-diamminedichloroplatinum II (CDDP)
  • chemotherapeutic agents include antimetabolites such as folic acid analogs (e.g., methotrexate (amethopterin)); pyrimidine analogs (e.g., fluorouracil (′5-fluorouracil; 5-FU); floxuridine (fluorode-oxyuridine); FUdr; Cytarabine (cyosine arabinoside), etc.); purine analogs (e.g., Mercaptopurine (6-mercaptopurine; 6-MP); Thioguanine (6-thioguanine; TG); and Pentostatin (2′-deoxycoformycin)), etc.
  • folic acid analogs e.g., methotrexate (amethopterin)
  • pyrimidine analogs e.g., fluorouracil (′5-fluorouracil; 5-FU); floxuridine (fluorode-oxyuridine); FUdr; Cytarabine (cyosine arabinoside
  • chemotherapeutic agents also include vinca alkaloids (e.g., vinblastin (VLB) and vincristine); topoisomerase inhibitors (e.g., etoposide, teniposide, camptothecin, topotecan, 9-amino-campotothecin CPT-11, etc.); antibiotics (e.g., dactinomycin (actinomycin D), adriamycin, daunorubicin, doxorubicin, bleomycin, plicamycin (mithramycin), mitomycin (mitomycin C), taxol, taxotere, etc.); enzymes (e.g., L-asparaginase); and biological response modifiers (e.g., interferon- ⁇ ; interleukin 2, etc.).
  • vinca alkaloids e.g., vinblastin (VLB) and vincristine
  • topoisomerase inhibitors e.g., etoposide
  • chemotherapeutic agents include cis-diaminedichloroplatinum II (CDDP); crboplatin; anthracendione (e.g, mitoxantrone); hydroxyurea; procarbazine (N-methylhydrazine); and adrenocortical suppressants (e.g., mitotane, aminoglutethimide, etc.).
  • CDDP cis-diaminedichloroplatinum II
  • crboplatin anthracendione
  • anthracendione e.g, mitoxantrone
  • hydroxyurea hydroxyurea
  • procarbazine N-methylhydrazine
  • adrenocortical suppressants e.g., mitotane, aminoglutethimide, etc.
  • chemotherapeutic agents include adrenocorticosteroids (e.g., prednisone); progestins (e.g., hydroxyprogesterone caproate; medroxyprogesterone acetate, megestrol acetate, etc.); estrogens (e.g., diethylstilbestrol; ethenyl estradiol, etc.); antiestrogens (e.g tamoxifen, etc.); androgens (e.g., testosterone propionate, fluoxymesterone, etc.); antiandrogens (e.g., flutamide); and gonadotropin-releasing hormone analogs (e.g., leuprolide).
  • adrenocorticosteroids e.g., prednisone
  • progestins e.g., hydroxyprogesterone caproate; medroxyprogesterone acetate, megestrol acetate, etc.
  • estrogens
  • antibiotic agents include antibiotics known in the art to treat microbial infections.
  • anti-biotic agents include, but are not limited to, amoxicillin, aminoglycoside, aminoglycoside analogs, beta-lactam, beta-lactamase, beta-lactamase analogs, clindamycin, chloramphenicol, cephalosporin, cephalosporin analogs, ciprofloxacin, ciprofloxacin analogs, erythromycin, fluoroquinolone, fluoroquinolone analogs, macrolide, macrolide analogs, metronidazole, penicillin, penicillin analogs, quinolone, quinolone analogs, rifampin, streptomycin, sulfonamide, tetracycline, tetracycline analogs, trimethoprim, trimethoprim-sulfamthoxazole, and vancomycin.
  • rescue medication refers to any medication commenced during treatment which has the potential to suppress the underlying disease, but which is introduced with the primary indication of ameliorating features of progressive AA amyloidosis.
  • Such medications may include, but are not limited to, colchicine, cytotoxic agents, and anti-TNF agents.
  • anti-TNF agents include agents which inhibit TNF, e.g., anti-TNF ⁇ antibodies.
  • anti-TNF agents include etanercept (EnbrelTM, Amgen), infliximab (RemicadeTM, Johnson and Johnson, see, for example U.S. Pat. No. 6,790,444), human anti-TNF monoclonal antibody (D2E7/HUMIRATM, Abbott Laboratories), CDP 571 (Celltech), and CDP 870 (Celltech).
  • Examples of other second agents include immunosuppressants, corticosteroids (including systemically administered corticosteroids), sulfasalazine, renin-angiotensin system blockers or antagonists, diuretics (e.g., furosemide), calcium channel blockers, beta blocking agents, antirheumatic products, Angiotensin converting enzyme inhibitors (ACEi), Angiotensin II receptor blockers (ARBs), acetylsalicylic acid, amoxicillin, calcium, calcium carbonate, chlorambucil, colchicine, cyclophosphamide, diclofenac, enalapril, folic acid, methotrexate, methylprednisolone, omeprazole, paracetamol, prednisolone, and prednisone.
  • ACEi Angiotensin converting enzyme inhibitors
  • ARBs Angiotensin II receptor blockers
  • acetylsalicylic acid am
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating an inflammatory disease in a subject.
  • the method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a second agent such that the inflammatory disease is treated in the subject.
  • the second agent is an anti-inflammatory agent.
  • inflammatory disease include diseases or disorders which are associated with inflammation and can be treated using the compounds of the invention.
  • the inflammatory disease may include diseases which are associated with, cause, caused by, result from, or otherwise related to amyloidosis, e.g., AA amyloidosis.
  • inflammatory diseases include, but are not limited to chronic inflammatory disease, rheumatoid arthritis, juvenile chronic arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriasis, psoriatic arthropathy, Reiter's syndrome, Adult Still's disease, Behcet's syndrome, familial Mediterranean fever, inflammatory bowel disease, hereditary periodic fevers, psoriatic arthritis, lupus erythematosus arthritis, periarthritis nodosa, Wegner's granulomatosis, Muckle-Wells syndrome and Crohn's disease.
  • chronic inflammatory disease include, but are not limited to chronic inflammatory disease, rheumatoid arthritis, juvenile chronic arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriasis, psoriatic arthropathy, Reiter's syndrome, Adult Still's disease, Behcet's syndrome, familial Mediterranean fever, inflammatory bowel disease, hereditary periodic fevers, psoriatic arthritis
  • the therapeutically effective amount of the compound of the invention is effective to treat, prevent or delay the onset of AA amyloidosis and the second agent is administered in an effective amount to treat the underlying disorder, e.g., an underlying inflammatory disorder.
  • the invention includes a method of treating rheumatoid arthritis in a subject.
  • the method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a second agent such that rheumatoid arthritis is treated in the subject.
  • the second agent is an anti-inflammatory agent.
  • the second agent is infliximab, which may be administered, for example by the procedure described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,790,444, incorporated herein by reference.
  • the second agent is an agent which is known to treat inflammatory diseases such as chronic inflammatory disease, rheumatoid arthritis, juvenile chronic arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriasis, psoriatic arthropathy, Reiter's syndrome, familial Mediterranean fever, Adult Still's disease, Behcet's syndrome, inflammatory bowel disease, psoriatic arthritis, lupus erythematosus arthritis, periarthritis nodosa, Wegner's granulomatosis, Muckle-Wells syndrome, hereditary periodic fevers, or Crohn's disease.
  • agents which may be administered to the subject include, for example, anti-TNF agents, methotrexate, anti-inflammatory agents, and combinations thereof.
  • the therapeutically effective amount of the compound of the invention is effective to treat, prevent or delay the onset of AA amyloidosis and the second agent is administered in an effective amount to treat rheumatoid arthritis.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating a malignant neoplasm in a subject.
  • the method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a second agent such that the malignant neoplasm is treated in the subject.
  • malignant neoplasm includes neoplasms which can be treated using the compounds of the invention.
  • the malignant neoplasms may include neoplasms which are associated with, caused by, cause, result from, or otherwise related to amyloidosis, e.g., AA amyloidosis.
  • Examples of such malignant neoplasms include, but are not limited to, Hodgkin's lymphoma, renal carcinoma, gut carcinoma, lung carcinoma, urogenital tract carcinoma, basal cell carcinoma, hepatoma, Castleman's disease, Schnitzler's syndrome, Waldenstrom's disease, or hairy cell leukemia.
  • the therapeutically effective amount of the compound of the invention is effective to treat, prevent or delay the onset of AA amyloidosis and the second agent is administered in an effective amount to treat malignant neoplasm.
  • the invention pertains to methods of treating chronic infections.
  • the methods include administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a second agent such that the chronic infection is treated.
  • chronic infections includes chronic viral, bacterial, fungal, and microbial infections which can be treated using the compounds of the invention.
  • the infections may include infections which are associated with, cause, caused by, result from, or otherwise related to amyloidosis, e.g., AA amyloidosis.
  • the microbial infections may be local or systemic.
  • microbial infections include, but are not limited to, acne conglobata, common variable immunodeficiency, hypolagammaglobulinemia, cystic fibrosis, leprosy, tuberculosis, bronchiectasis, decubitus ulcers, pyelonephritis, osteomyelitis, pulmonary tuberculosis, pulmonary infection(s), recurrent abscesses, Behcet's disease, and Whipple's disease.
  • Other chronic infections include AIDS, HIV, hepatitis B, and hepatitis C.
  • second agents which may be useful for the treatment of infections include agents which are known to treat AIDS, HIV, hepatitis B, hepatitis C, leprosy, tuberculosis, bronchiectasis, decubitus ulcers, pyelonephritis, osteomyelitis, acne conglobata, common variable immunodeficiency, hypolagammaglobulinemia, cystic fibrosis, pulmonary tuberculosis, pulmonary infection(s), recurrent abscesses, Behcet's disease, or Whipple's disease.
  • agents which may be administered to the subject include, for example, anti-inflammatory agents and antibiotic agents.
  • the therapeutically effective amount of the compound of the invention is effective to treat, prevent or delay the onset of AA amyloidosis and the second agent is administered in an effective amount to treat the chronic infection.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of increasing the oral bioavailability of a compound in a subject, by administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I) in a pharmaceutical composition without food such that the oral bioavailability of the compound in the subject is increased.
  • oral bioavailability refers to the quantity of drug reaching the bloodstream after oral administration.
  • increased oral bioavailability refers to an increase in the bioavailability of about 5% or greater, about 10% or greater, about 15% or greater, about 20% or greater, about 25% or greater, about 30% or greater, about 35% or greater, about 40% or greater, about 50% or greater, about 55% or greater, about 60% or greater, about 65% or greater, about 70% or greater, about 75% or greater, about 80% or greater, about 85% or greater, about 90% or greater, about 95% or greater, or about 100% or greater.
  • the administration of the compound of the invention without food results in an increase in the maximal plasma concentration (C max ) and extent of absorption (AUC) of the compound as compared to administration with food.
  • the increase of the C max and/or the AUC may be about 5% or greater, about 10% or greater, about 15% or greater, about 20% or greater, about 25% or greater, about 30% or greater, about 35% or greater, about 40% or greater, about 50% or greater, about 55% or greater, about 60% or greater, about 65% or greater, about 70% or greater, about 75% or greater, about 80% or greater, about 85% or greater, about 90% or greater, about 95% or greater, or about 100% or greater as compared to administration of the compound with food.
  • the subject is informed (e.g., by instructions by a physician or pharmacist, or by a label or insert accompanying the compound of the invention) that the administration results in an increase in the maximal plasma concentration (C max ) and extent of absorption (AUC) of the compound as compared to administration with food.
  • C max maximal plasma concentration
  • AUC extent of absorption
  • administration without food refers to the administration of a medication or a composition of the present invention on a substantially empty stomach. Accordingly, in some embodiments, administration without food includes administration more than 15 minutes, 30 minutes, 60 minutes, 90 minutes, 120 minutes, 150 minutes, 3 hours, 4 hours, 5 hours, 6 hours, 7 hours or 8 hours after the most recent consumption of food. In other embodiments, administration without food includes administration at least 15 minutes, 30 minutes, 60 minutes, 90 minutes, 120 minutes, 150 minutes, 3 hours, 4 hours, 5 hours, 6 hours, 7 hours or 8 hours before the next consumption of food. In one embodiment, the term “without food” is administration of the compound of the invention at least one hour before a meal or at least two hours after a meal. In this embodiment, the term “about” includes values ⁇ 10-20% of the indicated period.
  • the invention pertains to a method of reducing the rate of progression of nephropathy in a subject in need thereof, as measured by, e.g., the occurrence of a doubling of serum creatinine, greater than or equal to a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance, dialysis/end-stage renal disease, and/or all-cause mortality.
  • The may, for example, have AA amyloidosis, rheumatoid arthritis, chronic inflammation, chronic infection, hereditary fever, etc.
  • the invention in another embodiment, pertains to a method for preventing or delaying progression to End Stage Renal Disease (ESRD) and/or dialysis in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that progression to ESRD and/or dialysis is delayed or prevented.
  • the progression to ESRD and/or dialysis is delayed by 1 month or longer, 2 months or longer, 3 months or longer, 4 months or longer, 5 months or longer, 6 months or longer, 7 months or longer, 8 months or longer, 9 months or longer, 10 months or longer, or 12 months or longer.
  • dialysis and/or ESRD is delayed six months as compared to a standard subject with a similar disorder who has not been treated with the compound of the invention.
  • the risk of progressing to ESRD is reduced by about 0-78%.
  • the risk is decreased by about 5%, by about 10%, by about 15%, by about 20%, by about 25%, by about 30%, by about 35%, by about 40%, by about 45%, by about 50%, by about 55%, by about 60%, by about 65%, by about 70%, by about 75%, or by about 78%.
  • the term “about” includes values ⁇ 5%.
  • the median time to dialysis is delayed by at least about 1 month, about 2 months, about 3 months, about 4 months, about 5 months, about 6 months, about 7 months, about 8 months, or about 9 months.
  • the term “about” includes the range of ⁇ 0.5 months of the indicated period.
  • the median time to dialysis is 3.5 months ⁇ 5.5, or up to 9 months longer in subjects with a compound of formula (I), e.g., PDS.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for preventing or delaying the time to the doubling of serum creatinine in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the time to the doubling of serum creatinine is delayed or prevented.
  • the invention includes a method for preventing or delaying the time to at least 50% decrease in creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound, such that the time to the at least 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is delayed or prevented.
  • the median time to at least a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is about 1 month, about 2 months, about 3 months, about 4 months, about 5 months, about 6 months, about 7 months, about 8 months, about 9 months, about 10 months, about 11 months or about 12 months in subjects treated with compounds of formula (I), such as PDS.
  • the term “about” includes the range of ⁇ 0.5 months of the indicated period.
  • the median time to at least a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is up to 12 months longer in PDS treated patients.
  • the time to doubling of serum creatinine and/or the at least 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is delayed by 1 month or longer, 2 months or longer, 3 months or longer, 4 months or longer, 5 months or longer, 6 months or longer, 7 months or longer, 8 months or longer, 9 months or longer, 10 months or longer, or 12 months or longer.
  • the 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is delayed about 3 to about 5 months, or about 4 months.
  • the doubling of serum creatinine and/or the at least 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is delayed at least about six months as compared to standard subject with a similar disorder who has not been treated with the compound of the invention.
  • the time to the doubling of serum creatinine is delayed by about 3 months to about 5 months, or about 4 months.
  • the invention includes a method for decreasing the time to at least 50% increase in creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the time to the at least 50% increase in creatinine clearance is decreased.
  • the time to an at least 50% increase in creatinine clearance is decreased by 1 month or longer, 2 months or longer, 3 months or longer, 4 months or longer, 5 months or longer, 6 months or longer, 7 months or longer, 8 months or longer, 9 months or longer, 10 months or longer, or 12 months or longer.
  • the at least 50% increase in creatinine clearance is decreased six months as compared to standard subject with a similar disorder who has not been treated with the compound of the invention.
  • the invention includes a method for reducing the rate of progression of renal disease as measured by the slope of creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the rate of progression of renal disease is reduced, as measured, e.g., by a decline in the rate of decrease of creatinine clearance.
  • the slope of creatinine clearance is reduced by about 0-10 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year. In another further embodiment, the slope of creatine clearance is reduced by about 1 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year, by about 2 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year, by about 3 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year, by about 4 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year, by about 5 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year, by about 6 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year, by about 7 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year, by about 8 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year, by about 9 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year, or by about 10 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year.
  • the slope of creatinine clearance is reduced by about 4.7 ⁇ 5 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year.
  • the term “about” includes values ⁇ 0.5 mL/min/1.73 m 2 /year.
  • the rate of progression of renal disease is reduced by about 10% or greater, about 20% or greater, about 30% or greater, about 40% or greater, about 50% or greater, or about 60% or greater. In a particular embodiment, the rate of progression of renal disease is reduced by about 30% to about 40%.
  • rate of change of creatinine clearance refers to the rate of change in creatinine clearance normalized for a subject's body surface area over time.
  • a subject's creatinine clearance can be measured through, for example, a 24 hr urine collection at designated time points.
  • This creatinine clearance is normalized for body surface area and the least-squares estimate of the within-subject slope may be calculated using available creatinine clearance measurements for that subject.
  • the slope of creatinine clearance is expressed as an annual rate of change.
  • a suitable transformation i.e. log transformation
  • the rate of change of a subject's creatinine clearance is improved by about 1 mL/min/year or more; about 2 mL/min/year or more; about 3 mL/min/year or more; about 4 mL/min/year or more; about 5 mL/min/year or more; about 6 mL/min/year or more; about 7 mL/min/year or more; about 8 mL/min/year or more; about 9 mL/min/year or more; or about 10 mL/min/year or more.
  • the decrease in the rate of the creatinine clearance is lessened by about 2 to about 5 mL/min/year.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for stabilizing or reducing proteinuria in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the proteinuria in the subject is stabilized or reduced.
  • the proteinuria is reduced by about 0.5 g/24 hours or more; about 1 g/24 hours; about 1.5 g/24 hours; or by about 2 g/24 hours.
  • the proteinuria is stabilized at below or equal to 1 g/24 hours.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for stabilizing renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the subject's renal function is stabilized or the progression of renal disease is delayed.
  • the progression of renal disease is delayed by 1 month or longer, 2 months or longer, 3 months or longer, 4 months or longer, 5 months or longer, 6 months or longer, 7 months or longer, 8 months or longer, 9 months or longer, 10 months or longer, or 12 months or longer.
  • the invention pertains to a method for treating renal impairment in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the renal impairment is treated
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for preventing or delaying progression to nephrotic syndrome in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), e.g. 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that progression to nephrotic syndrome is prevented or delayed.
  • a compound of Formula (I) e.g. 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for treating nephrotic syndrome in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), e.g. 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the parameters associated with nephrotic syndrome are improved or nephrotic syndrome is remitted.
  • a compound of Formula (I) e.g. 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for sustaining remission of nephrotic syndrome in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), e.g. 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that remission of nephrotic syndrome is sustained over a period of, e.g., about 4, 6, 8, 10 or 12 months.
  • remission of nephrotic syndrome is sustained in a patient over a period of about 6 to about 8 months.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for stabilizing or increasing GFR in a subject having AA amyloidosis.
  • the method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), e.g. 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that GFR is stabilized or increased.
  • a compound of Formula (I) e.g. 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt
  • GFR glomerular filtration rate
  • glomerular filtration rate and “GFR” are used interchangeably herein and are an indicator of kidney function.
  • One measure of a subject's GFR is the rate of creatinine clearance.
  • Renal function and/or GFR can be assessed using a number of criteria, such as, for example: serum creatinine levels, urinary creatinine levels, urinary albumin levels, urinary microproteins levels (e.g. retinol binding protein, N-acetyl- ⁇ -D-glucosaminidase, microalbumin, etc.), plasma clearance of inulin, creatinine clearance, proteinurea, etc.
  • serum creatinine levels e.g. retinol binding protein, N-acetyl- ⁇ -D-glucosaminidase, microalbumin, etc.
  • plasma clearance of inulin e.g. retinol binding protein, N-acetyl- ⁇ -D-glucosaminidase, microalbumin, etc
  • a subject may have mild, moderate or severe renal impairment.
  • a healthy subject typically has a GFR of greater than about 100 mL/min.
  • a subject with “mild” renal impairment may, for example, have a GFR of about 50 to about 80 mL/min or a GFR of less than 100, or a creatinine clearance rate of about 60 to about 90 mL/min.
  • a subject with “moderate” renal impairment may, for example, have a GFR of about 30 to about 50 mL/min, or a creatinine clearance rate of about 30 to about 60 mL/min.
  • a subject with “severe” renal impairment may, for example, have a GFR of less than about 30 mL/min, or a creatinine clearance rate of about 15 to about 30 mL/min.
  • Subjects may also be classified as mild, moderate or severe as described in the examples herein, or using criteria known in the art (see, e.g., McCullough, P. A., Rev. Cardiovasc. Med. 2003; 4(suppl. 1): S2-S6; K/DOQI guidelines at www.kidney.org/professionals).
  • a subject may have a creatine clearance rate, before treatment (e.g., at baseline) of about 50 to about 120 mL/min, about 60 to about 100 mL/min, about 70 to about 110 ml/min, or about 70 to about 100 ml/min.
  • the subject is nephrotic. In another further embodiment, the subject is non-nephrotic.
  • the subject may be suffering from a disorder such as, for example, an inflammatory disorder, a malignant neoplasm, or a chronic infection.
  • the invention pertains to compounds of formula (I):
  • Y is SO 3 X or OSO 3 X independently chosen for each occurrence;
  • X is cationic group independently chosen for each occurrence;
  • n is 1, 2, 3 or 4;
  • m is 1 or 2, provided that when m is 2, one hydrogen of the —(CH 2 ) n — group is absent.
  • cationic group includes groups with a positive charge and hydrogen atoms.
  • examples of cations include pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the SO 3 ⁇ or OSO 3 ⁇ .
  • examples of cationic groups include ions of alkali or alkaline earth metals, such as lithium, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and aluminum and the like. In a further embodiment, the cationic groups are H + or Na + .
  • Examples of compounds of the invention include the compounds below and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
  • 1,2-Ethanedisulfonic acid HO 3 SCH 2 CH 2 SO 3 H
  • Sodium 1,2-ethanedisulfonate NaO 3 SCH 2 CH 2 SO 3 NA 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid HO 3 SCH 2 CH 2 CH 2 SO 3 H
  • Sodium 1,3-propanedisulfonate (1,3- NaO 3 SCH 2 CH 2 CH 2 SO 3 Na propanedisulfonic acid, disodium salt) 1,2-Ethanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate) HO 3 SOCH 2 CH 2 OSO 3 H
  • 1,2-Ethanediol disulfate, disodium NaO 3 SOCH 2 CH 2 OSO 3 Na salt 1,3-Propanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate) HO 3 SOCH 2 CH 2 CH 2 OSO 3 H 1,3-Propanediol disulfate, disodium NaO 3 SOCH 2 CH 2 CH 2 OSO 3 Na salt 2-Sulfo
  • the compound or anti-amyloidogenic agent is not 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid. In another embodiment, the compound or anti-amyloidogenic agent is not 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt.
  • the term “compound” includes chemical entities.
  • the compounds may be in solid, liquid or gaseous phase.
  • the term compound includes the compounds of formula (I) and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
  • Compounds of the invention are identified herein by their chemical structure and/or chemical name. Where a compound is referred to by both a chemical structure and a chemical name, and that chemical structure and chemical name conflict, the chemical structure is determinative of the compound's identity.
  • the compounds of the invention may contain a chiral center and, therefore, may exist as stereoisomers.
  • Compounds, as defined herein may be purified from natural sources, purchased from commercial sources or chemically synthesized using art recognized techniques.
  • the compounds of the invention also may exist in hydrated and anhydrous forms. Hydrates of the compound of formula (I) are included as compounds of formula (I).
  • the compound of formula (I) is a monohydrate.
  • the compound of formula (I) comprises about 10% or less, about 9% or less, about 8% or less, about 7% or less, about 6% or less, about 5% or less, about 4% or less, about 3% or less, about 2% or less, about 1% or less, about 0.5% or less, about 0.1% or less by weight of water.
  • the compounds of the invention comprise, about 0.1% or more, about 0.5% or more, about 1% or more, about 2% or more, about 3% or more, about 4% or more, about 5% or more, or about 6% or more by weight of water.
  • the compounds of the invention may also encompass more than one polymorphic forms, hydrated states, etc.
  • one form, Form I can be prepared by direct recrystallization of a compound of the invention, e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid, disodium salt. The compound is precipitated from solution with 16:1 ethanol:water (v/v). The recrystallized product is recovered as a fine white powder which is then dried at 65° C. for 16 hours at 4 mm Hg. The resulting non-hydrated form has a moisture content of 0.2% and an apparent density of 0.64 g/ml. In a further embodiment, the compound of formula (I) has a moisture content of about 0.2%.
  • Form II can be prepared by direct recrystallization of a commercially available 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid, disodium salt in a fashion similar to Form I.
  • the compound is precipitated from solution with 8:1 ethanol:water (v/v).
  • the recrystallized product is recovered as a white solid which is then dried at 20-25° C. for 16 hours at 4 mm Hg.
  • the resulting mono-hydrated form has a moisture content of about 7% w/w and an apparent density of 0.46 g/ml.
  • the compound of formula (I) has a moisture content of about 7%.
  • Form I can be also be prepared from the Form II polymorph by prolonged heating at reduced pressures.
  • the Form II polymorph water content 6.8%
  • This initial drying reduces the water content of the formerly hydrated polymorph to 2.3%.
  • the moisture content of the formerly monohydrated polymorph is reduced to 1%.
  • the compound is entirely converted to Form I polymorph only after an additional 48 hours of drying at 77° C.
  • the compounds of the present invention contain one or more acidic functional groups and, thus, are capable of forming pharmaceutically acceptable salts with pharmaceutically acceptable bases.
  • pharmaceutically acceptable salts in these instances refers to the relatively non-toxic, inorganic and organic base addition salts of compounds of the present invention.
  • salts can likewise be prepared in situ during the final isolation and purification of the agents, or by separately reacting the purified agent in its free acid form with a suitable base, such as the hydroxide, carbonate or bicarbonate of a pharmaceutically acceptable metal cation, with ammonia, or with a pharmaceutically acceptable organic primary, secondary or tertiary amine.
  • a suitable base such as the hydroxide, carbonate or bicarbonate of a pharmaceutically acceptable metal cation, with ammonia, or with a pharmaceutically acceptable organic primary, secondary or tertiary amine.
  • Representative alkali or alkaline earth salts include the lithium, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and aluminum salts and the like.
  • Representative organic amines useful for the formation of base addition salts include ethylamine, diethylamine, ethylenediamine, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, piperazine and the like.
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable salts” also includes, for example, derivatives of agents modified by making base salts thereof, as described further below and elsewhere in the present application.
  • Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable salts include alkali or organic salts of acidic residues such as sulfonates.
  • Pharmaceutically acceptable salts include the conventional non-toxic salts or the quaternary ammonium salts of the parent agent formed, for example, from non-toxic inorganic or organic acids.
  • Such conventional non-toxic salts include those derived from inorganic acids such as hydrochloric, hydrobromic, sulfuric, sulfamic, phosphoric, and nitric acid; and the salts prepared from organic acids such as acetic, propionic, succinic, glycolic, stearic, lactic, malic, tartaric, citric, ascorbic, palmoic, maleic, hydroxymaleic, phenylacetic, glutamic, mesylate, benzoic, salicylic, sulfanilic, 2-acetoxybenzoic, fumaric, toluenesulfonic, methanesulfonic, ethane disulfonic, oxalic, and isethionic acid.
  • inorganic acids such as hydrochloric, hydrobromic, sulfuric, sulfamic, phosphoric, and nitric acid
  • organic acids such as acetic, propionic, succinic, glycolic, stearic, lactic
  • salts may be synthesized from the parent agent which contains a basic or acidic moiety by conventional chemical methods. Generally, such salts may be prepared by reacting the free acid or base forms of these agents with a stoichiometric amount of the appropriate base or acid in water or in an organic solvent, or in a mixture of the two.
  • All acid, salt, base, and other ionic and non-ionic forms of the compounds described are included as compounds of the invention.
  • the salt forms of the compound are also included.
  • the acid and/or basic forms are also included.
  • the compound of formula (I) is not 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid.
  • the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation for treating AA amyloidosis, comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in a formulation such that the formulation has at least one favorable biological property (FBP) upon administration to a subject.
  • a pharmaceutical formulation for treating AA amyloidosis comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in a formulation such that the formulation has at least one favorable biological property (FBP) upon administration to a subject.
  • FBP biological property
  • pharmaceutical formulation includes pharmaceutical compositions as described below.
  • the pharmaceutical formulations are designed to have favorable biological properties which enhance the ability of the compounds of the invention to treat AA amyloidosis and/or amyloid related diseases.
  • the favorable biological properties of the formulation were discovered by administering the compounds of the invention to subjects during clinical trials.
  • the term “favorable biological property” includes biological properties other than the ability of the compound of the invention to inhibit AA amyloidosis and/or treat an amyloid related disease, which enhance the ability of the compound of the invention to perform its intended function, e.g., treat AA amyloidosis and/or an amyloid related disease.
  • the favorable biological properties can be a pharmacokinetic profile. Examples of such parameters which may be used, include, but are not limited to C max , C ss , T max , AUC 0-t , AUC ⁇ , and T 1/2 .
  • C max , T max , AUC 0-t , AUC ⁇ , and T 1/2 may be derived, for example, by non-compartmental analysis using WinNonlin® (Pharsight Corporation, Mountain View, Calif.) or SAS® for Windows® (SAS Institute Inc., Cary, N.C.).
  • the favorable biological property is a target plasma concentration or a target systemic exposure.
  • C max refers to the maximum observed plasma concentration of the compound of the invention in a particular subject.
  • C ss refers to the steady state plasma concentration of the compound of the invention in a particular subject.
  • T max refers to the time of the occurrence of the C max .
  • AUC 0-t refers to the area under the plasma concentration versus time curve from time zero to the last sampling time at which concentrations were at or above the limit of quantification, calculated by the linear trapezoidal rule.
  • AUC ⁇ refers to the area under the plasma concentrations versus time curve from time zero to infinity, calculated from AUC 0-t +(C last / ⁇ z ), where C last is the last observed quantifiable concentration and ⁇ z is the apparent terminal rate constant.
  • T 1/2 refers to the apparent terminal half-life, calculated from ln 2 ⁇ z .
  • the invention also includes formulations and compositions which combine two or more favorable biological properties, such as pharmacokinetic parameters or combinations thereof.
  • these pharmacokinetic parameters include AUC 0-t , AUC ⁇ , C max and/or T max .
  • the formulations of the invention may be selected such that when administered to a healthy subject (or one without renal impairment), the selected formulation provides the subject with one or more of the desired pharmacokinetic parameters.
  • the formulations of the invention may be selected such that when administered to a subject with impaired renal function and/or subjects with AA amyloidosis or at risk for AA amyloidosis, the selected formulation provides the subject with one or more of the desired pharmacokinetic parameters.
  • the formulation is not as described in Example 7.
  • at least one ingredient is not an ingredient described in Example 7.
  • the formulation has a diluent that is not lactose monohydrate.
  • diluents that are not lactose monohydrate include, for example, sugars (e.g., glucose, sucrose, fructose, etc.), starches (e.g., corn starch, potato starch, etc.), cellulose, derivatives of cellulose (e.g., sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose, cellulose acetate, etc.), powdered tragacanth, malt, gelatin, talc, and mixtures thereof.
  • the hygroscopicity of the diluent and/or lubricant is selected such that the resulting capsules are acceptable under FDA regulations.
  • the formulation has a lubricant that is not magnesium stearate.
  • lubricants that are not magnesium stearate include, for example, stearic acid powder, talc, calcium stearate, polyethylene glycol, sodium lauryl sulfate, and mixtures thereof.
  • the formulation comprises less than about 0.5% (w/w) of any single known impurity, less than about 1.5% (w/w) of total sulfates, less than about 0.1% (w/w) total unknown impurities, and less than about 5.0% (w/w) impurities overall.
  • the compound of formula (I) conforms to a reference standard IR (Infrared) spectra and/or IC (ion chromatography) of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid.
  • the compound of formula (I) comprises less than about 1.0% w/w of water.
  • the compound of formula (I) less than about 20 ppm of heavy metals and/or less than about 0.5% w/w residual solvent.
  • the invention pertains to a biologically favorable formulation for treating AA amyloidosis, comprising an anti-amyloidogenic agent in a formulation such that the anti-amyloidogenic agent-containing formulation is equivalent to a standard formulation predetermined to have at least one favorable biological property upon administration to a subject such that it is a biologically favorable formulation.
  • biologically favorable formulation refers to a pharmaceutical formulation with at least one favorable biological property.
  • the formulation has two or more, three or more, or four or more biologically favorable properties.
  • the biologically favorable formulation is formulated such that a target plasma concentration of the compound of the invention is reached in the subject 30 minutes or less, one hour or less, two hours or less, or five hours or less after administration of the compound to a subject.
  • the biologically favorable formulation is selected based on a subject's creatinine clearance rate in order to achieve a particular AUC ss and/or C ss .
  • the favorable biological property may be an AUC ss of about 5000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above, about 6000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 6500 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 7000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 8000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 9000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 10,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 11,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 12,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 13,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 14,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 15,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 16,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 17,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 18,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 19,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 20,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above, about 21,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 22,000 ng ⁇
  • the biologically favorable property may be a desirable steady state concentration (C ss ).
  • the favorable biological property may be a C ss of about 500 ng/mL or above, about 600 ng/mL or above; about 700 ng/mL or above; about 800 ng/mL or above; about 900 ng/mL or above; about 950 or above ng/mL; about 1000 ng/mL or above; about 1100 ng/mL or above; or about 1200 ng/mL.
  • the biologically favorable property may be a C ss of about 1200 ng/mL or less, about 1100 ng/mL or less; about 1000 ng/mL or less; about 900 ng/mL or less; about 800 ng/mL or less; about 700 ng/mL or less; about 600 ng/mL or less; or less than about 500 ng/mL.
  • the favorable biological property may be a C max (after a single oral administration of the compound) of about 250 to about 2000 ng/mL.
  • the C max is about 250 ng/mL or greater; about 300 ng/mL or greater; about 350 ng/mL or greater; about 400 ng/mL or greater; about 500 ng/mL or greater; about 600 ng/mL or greater; about 700 ng/mL or greater; about 800 ng/mL or greater; about 900 ng/mL or greater; about 1000 ng/mL or greater; about 1100 ng/mL or greater; about 1200 ng/mL or greater; about 1300 ng/mL or greater; about 1400 ng/mL or greater; about 1500 ng/mL or greater; about 1600 ng/mL or greater; about 1700 ng/mL or greater; about 1800 ng/mL or greater; about 1900 ng/ml, or greater; or about 2000 ng/mL or greater.
  • the C max after administration of a single oral dose is about 850 ng/mL; about 1700 ng/mL or less; about 1600 ng/mL or less; about 1500 ng/mL or less; about 1400 ng/mL or less; about 1300 ng/mL or less; about 1200 ng/mL or less; about 1000 ng/mL or less; about 900 ng/mL or less; about 800 ng/mL or less; about 700 or less; about 700 ng/mL or less; about 500 ng/mL or less; about 400 ng/mL or less; or about 300 ng/mL or less.
  • the C max is at least 200 ng/mL after administration of a single oral dose of the compound.
  • the term “about” in this embodiment includes values ⁇ 50 ng/mL of the indicated range.
  • the favorable biological property may be a C max (after multiple oral administrations of the compound) of about 400 to about 3800 ng/mL.
  • the C max is about 400 ng/mL or greater; about 500 ng/mL or greater; about 600 ng/mL or greater; about 700 ng/mL or greater; about 800 ng/mL or greater; about 900 ng/mL or greater; about 1000 ng/mL or greater; about 1100 ng/mL or greater; about 1200 ng/mL or greater; about 1300 ng/mL or greater; about 1400 ng/mL or greater; about 1500 ng/mL or greater; about 1600 ng/mL or greater; about 1700 ng/mL or greater; about 1800 ng/mL or greater; about 1900 ng/mL or greater; about 2000 ng/mL or greater; about 2100 ng/mL or greater; about 2200 or greater; about 2300 ng/mL or greater; about 2400
  • the C max (after multiple oral administrations) is about 500 to about 3900 ng/ml. In a further embodiment, the C max is about 500 ng/ml or less, about 600 ng/ml or less; about 700 ng/ml or less; about 900 ng/ml or less; about 1000 ng/mL or less; about 1100 ng/mL or less; about 1200 ng/mL; about 1300 ng/mL or less; about 1400 ng/mL or less; about 1500 ng/mL or less; about 1600 ng/mL or less; about 1700 ng/mL or less; about 1800 ng/mL or less; about 1900 ng/mL or less; about 2000 ng/mL or less; about 2100 ng/mL or less; about 2200 or less; about 2300 ng/mL or less; about 2400 ng/mL or less; about 2500 ng/mL or less; about 2600 ng/mL or less; about
  • the favorable biological property may be an AUC ⁇ of about 2000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above, about 3000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above, about 4000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above, about 5000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above, about 6000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 6500 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 7000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 8000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 9000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 10,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 11,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 12,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 13,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 14,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 15,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 16,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 17,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 18,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or above; about 19,000 ng ⁇ h/h/
  • the favorable biological property is an AUC ⁇ of about 2000 ng ⁇ h/ml; about 3000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less, about 4000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less, about 5000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less, about 5000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less, about 6000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 6500 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 7000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 8000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 9000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 10,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 11,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 12,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 13,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 14,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 15,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 16,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 17,000 ng ⁇ h/mL or less; about 18,000 ng ⁇ h/mL
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation.
  • the pharmaceutical formulation comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about from 2900 to about 9000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20% and a mean C max of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • an active agent e.g., PDS
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about from 2900 to about 9000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20% and a mean C max of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of from about 2,900 to about 9,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • an active agent e.g., PDS
  • the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean C max of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • an active agent e.g., PDS
  • a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean C max of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved.
  • the invention pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 10,000-12,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 800-900 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 9,000-10,500 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 750-875 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1200 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 5,000-6,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%
  • the invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising 800 mgs of an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject: when said subject is healthy, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 4,000-6,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 1,200-1,300 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the subject has mild renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 12,000-14,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 2,500-3,500 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or when the subject has moderate renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 9,000-11,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 2,000-2,200 ng/mL ⁇ 2
  • an active agent
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis for twenty-four months: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 25,000-26,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 2,000-2,300 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 20,000-22,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 1,600-2,000 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1200 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 8,000-10,000
  • an active agent
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to healthy male subjects for seven days: in a dose of 400 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 10,000-11,500 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 900-1100 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 19,000-21,000 ng ⁇ h/mL ⁇ 20%, and a mean C max of about 1,600-1,800 ng/mL ⁇ 20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1600 mg TID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC ⁇ of about 25,000-27,000 ng ⁇ h/mL
  • an active agent
  • equivalent refers to a formulation which is considered a bioequivalent or functionally equivalent to a formulation of the invention.
  • the formulation is equivalent to a formulation comprising 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid.
  • the term includes formulations which meet the definition of bioequivalence under 21 U.S.C. ⁇ 255 and/or 21 CFR ⁇ 320.
  • “equivalent” refers to a formulation which, when administered to a subject, achieves pharmacokinetic parameters, e.g., C max , AUC ⁇ , that are within, for example, +10%, +20%, ⁇ 30%, or ⁇ 40% of the values disclosed herein.
  • the term “equivalent” includes potentially equivalent formulations, wherein the rate and extent of absorption of the potentially equivalent formulation do not show a significant difference, e.g., within ⁇ 10%, ⁇ 20%, ⁇ 30%, or ⁇ 40% of the rate and extent of absorption of the standard formulation when administered under similar experimental conditions
  • the extent of absorption of the potentially equivalent formulation does not show a significant difference, e.g., within ⁇ 10%, ⁇ 20%, ⁇ 30%, or ⁇ 40% of the rate and extent of absorption of the standard formulation when administered under similar experimental conditions and the difference from standard formulation is not essential to the attainment of effective body drug concentrations on chronic use, and/or is considered medically insignificant for the drug.
  • the same molar dose may be administered.
  • standard formulation refers to a formulation of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid, which has at least one favorable biological property.
  • the standard formulation meets or exceeds the requirements of the drug product specifications.
  • the standard formulation is the formulation described in Example 7.
  • drug product specifications refers to a formulation wherein the formulation meets U.S. FDA drug product specifications.
  • the formulation comprises not more than about 0.5% w/w of any single known impurity, not more than about 1.5% w/w of total sulfates, not more than 0.1% w/w of any single unknown impurity, and not more than about 5.0% w/w total impurities.
  • anti-amyloidogenic agent refers to a compound which tests positive in the AA Amyloid Binding Assay (AAABA).
  • AAABA Amyloid Binding Assay
  • the anti-amyloidogenic agent binds to AA at a rate of 30% or greater, 45% or greater, 60% or greater, 70% or greater, 80% or greater, or 90% or greater at an AA amyloid concentration of 400 ⁇ M as measured in the AAABA.
  • the anti-amyloidogenic compound binds to AA at a rate of 30% or greater, 45% or greater, 60% or greater, 70% or greater, 80% or greater, or 90% or greater at an AA amyloid concentration of 200 ⁇ M, as measured in the AAABA.
  • anti-amyoloidogenic agent also includes disulfonated compounds and sulfonated alkyl compounds.
  • the term includes compounds which are analogs of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • the anti-amyloidogenic agent is a compound of formula (I), as described above.
  • anti-amyloidogenic agents include compounds such as 1,2-ethanedisulfonic acid, sodium 1,2-ethanedisulfonate, 1,2-ethanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate), 1,2-ethanediol disulfate disodium salt, 1,3-propanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate), 1,3-propanediol disulfate disodium salt, 2-sulfomethyl-1,4-butanedisulfonic acid, or 2-sulfomethylbutane-1,4-disulfonic acid trisodium salt.
  • the anti-amyloidogenic agent is 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt.
  • AAABA AA Amyloid Binding Assay
  • samples are prepared as aqueous solutions (adding 20% ethanol if necessary to solubilize in water), 200 ⁇ M of a test compound and 20 ⁇ M of solubilized AA, or 400 ⁇ M of a test compound and 40 ⁇ M of solubilized AA.
  • the pH value of each sample is adjusted to 7.4 ( ⁇ 0.2) by addition of 0.1% aqueous sodium hydroxide.
  • the solutions are then analyzed by electrospray ionization mass spectrometry using a Waters ZQ 4000 mass spectrometer. Samples are introduced by direct infusion at a flow-rate of 25 ⁇ L/min within 2 hours after sample preparation. The source temperature is kept at 70° C. and the cone voltage is 20 V for all the analysis. Data are processed using Masslynx 3.5 software.
  • the MS assay gives data on the ability of compounds to bind to soluble AA.
  • the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical composition
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) and second agent.
  • the therapeutically effective amount is effective to treat AA amyloidosis.
  • the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition.
  • the packaged pharmaceutical composition includes a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) packaged in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered in combination with a second agent.
  • the therapeutically effective amount is effective to treat AA amyloidosis.
  • the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition, which includes a therapeutically effective amount of a second agent packaged in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered in combination with a compound of formula (I).
  • label or insert includes, but is not limited to all written, electronic, or spoken communication with the subject, or with any person substantially responsible for the care of the subject, regarding the administration of the compositions of the present invention.
  • An insert may further include information regarding coadministration of the compositions of the present invention with other compounds or compositions, e.g., second agents. Additionally, an insert may include instructions regarding administration of the compositions of the present invention without food.
  • the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition, which includes a container holding a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered without food.
  • the compounds of formula (I) may be supplied in a solution with an appropriate solvent or in a solvent-free form (e.g., lyophilized).
  • the agents and buffers necessary for carrying out the methods of the invention may be packaged as a kit.
  • the kit may be commercially used according to the methods described herein and may include instructions for use in a method of the invention.
  • Additional kit components may include acids, bases, buffering agents, inorganic salts, solvents, antioxidants, preservatives, or metal chelators.
  • the additional kit components are present as pure compositions, or as aqueous or organic solutions that incorporate one or more additional kit components. Any or all of the kit components optionally further comprise buffers.
  • the compounds of formula (I) may also be administered parenterally, intraperitoneally, intraspinally, or intracerebrally.
  • Dispersions can be prepared in glycerol, liquid polyethylene glycols, and mixtures thereof and in oils. Under ordinary conditions of storage and use, these preparations may contain a preservative to prevent the growth of microorganisms.
  • the compound of the invention may be administered to a subject in an appropriate carrier, for example, liposomes, or a diluent.
  • suitable diluents include saline and aqueous buffer solutions.
  • Liposomes include water-in-oil-in-water CGF emulsions as well as conventional liposomes (Strejan et al., J. Neuroimmunol. 7, 27 (1984)).
  • pharmaceutical composition includes the “pharmaceutical formulations” described above.
  • compositions suitable for injectable use include sterile aqueous solutions (where water soluble) or dispersions and sterile powders for the extemporaneous preparation of sterile injectable solutions or dispersion.
  • the composition must be sterile and must be fluid to the extent that easy syringability exists. It must be stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage and must be preserved against the contaminating action of microorganisms such as bacteria and fungi.
  • Suitable pharmaceutically acceptable vehicles include, without limitation, any non-immunogenic pharmaceutical adjuvants suitable for oral, parenteral, nasal, mucosal, transdermal, intravascular (IV), intraarterial (IA), intramuscular (IM), and subcutaneous (SC) administration routes, such as phosphate buffer saline (PBS).
  • IV intravascular
  • IA intraarterial
  • IM intramuscular
  • SC subcutaneous
  • PBS phosphate buffer saline
  • the vehicle can be a solvent or dispersion medium containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (for example, glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like), suitable mixtures thereof, and vegetable oils.
  • the proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion and by the use of surfactants.
  • Prevention of the action of microorganisms can be achieved by various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, ascorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like.
  • isotonic agents are included, for example, sugars, sodium chloride, or polyalcohols such as mannitol and sorbitol, in the composition.
  • Prolonged absorption of the injectable compositions can be brought about by including in the composition an agent which delays absorption, for example, aluminum monostearate or gelatin.
  • Sterile injectable solutions can be prepared by incorporating the therapeutic agent in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filtered sterilization.
  • dispersions are prepared by incorporating the therapeutic agent into a sterile vehicle which contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above.
  • the methods of preparation are vacuum drying and freeze-drying which yields a powder of the active ingredient (i.e., the compound of the invention) plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof.
  • the compound of the invention can be orally administered, for example, with an inert diluent or an assimilable edible carrier.
  • the compound of the invention and other ingredients may also be enclosed in a hard or soft shell gelatin capsule, compressed into tablets, or incorporated directly into the subject's diet.
  • the compound of the invention may be incorporated with excipients and used in the form of ingestible tablets, buccal tablets, troches, capsules, elixirs, suspensions, syrups, wafers, and the like.
  • the percentage of the compound of the invention in the compositions and preparations may, of course, be varied.
  • the amount of the compound of the invention in such therapeutically useful compositions is such that a suitable dosage will be obtained.
  • the present invention therefore includes pharmaceutical formulations comprising the compounds of the invention, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, in pharmaceutically acceptable vehicles for aerosol, oral and parenteral administration. Also, the present invention includes such compounds, or salts thereof, which have been lyophilized and which may be reconstituted to form pharmaceutically acceptable formulations for administration, as by intravenous, intramuscular, or subcutaneous injection. Administration may also be intradermal or transdermal.
  • an agent of formula (I) described herein, and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof may be administered orally or through inhalation as a solid, or may be administered intramuscularly or intravenously as a solution, suspension or emulsion. Alternatively, the agents or salts may also be administered by inhalation, intravenously or intramuscularly as a liposomal suspension.
  • compositions or formulations are also provided which are suitable for administration as an aerosol, by inhalation.
  • These formulations comprise a solution or suspension of the desired compound of the invention, or a salt thereof, or a plurality of solid particles of the agent or salt.
  • the desired formulation may be placed in a small chamber and nebulized. Nebulization may be accomplished by compressed air or by ultrasonic energy to form a plurality of liquid droplets or solid particles comprising the agents or salts.
  • the liquid droplets or solid particles should have a particle size in the range of about 0.5 to about 5 microns.
  • the solid particles can be obtained by processing the solid agent of any compound of the invention, or a salt thereof, in any appropriate manner known in the art, such as by micronization.
  • the size of the solid particles or droplets will be, for example, from about 1 to about 2 microns. In this respect, commercial nebulizers are available to achieve this purpose.
  • a pharmaceutical formulation suitable for administration as an aerosol may be in the form of a liquid, the formulation will comprise a water-soluble agent of a compound of the invention, or a salt thereof, in a carrier which comprises water.
  • a surfactant may be present which lowers the surface tension of the formulation sufficiently to result in the formation of droplets within the desired size range when subjected to nebulization.
  • Peroral compositions also include liquid solutions, emulsions, suspensions, and the like.
  • the pharmaceutically acceptable vehicles suitable for preparation of such compositions are well known in the art.
  • Typical components of carriers for syrups, elixirs, emulsions and suspensions include ethanol, glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, liquid sucrose, sorbitol and water.
  • typical suspending agents include methyl cellulose, sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, tragacanth, and sodium alginate;
  • typical wetting agents include lecithin and polysorbate 80; and typical preservatives include methyl paraben and sodium benzoate.
  • Peroral liquid compositions may also contain one or more components such as sweeteners, flavoring agents and colorants disclosed above.
  • compositions may also be coated by conventional methods, typically with pH or time-dependent coatings, such that the subject agent is released in the gastrointestinal tract in the vicinity of the desired topical application, or at various times to extend the desired action.
  • dosage forms typically include, but are not limited to, one or more of cellulose acetate phthalate, polyvinylacetate phthalate, hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose phthalate, ethyl cellulose, waxes, and shellac.
  • compositions useful for attaining systemic delivery of the subject agents include sublingual, buccal and nasal dosage forms.
  • Such compositions typically comprise one or more of soluble filler substances such as sucrose, sorbitol and mannitol; and binders such as acacia, microcrystalline cellulose, carboxymethyl cellulose and hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose. Glidants, lubricants, sweeteners, colorants, antioxidants and flavoring agents disclosed above may also be included.
  • compositions of this invention can also be administered topically to a subject, e.g., by the direct laying on or spreading of the composition on the epidermal or epithelial tissue of the subject, or transdermally via a “patch”.
  • Such compositions include, for example, lotions, creams, solutions, gels and solids.
  • These topical compositions may comprise an effective amount, usually at least about 0.1%, or even from about 1% to about 5%, of a compound of the invention.
  • Suitable carriers for topical administration typically remain in place on the skin as a continuous film, and resist being removed by perspiration or immersion in water.
  • the carrier is organic in nature and capable of having dispersed or dissolved therein the therapeutic agent.
  • the carrier may include pharmaceutically acceptable emollients, emulsifiers, thickening agents, solvents and the like.
  • Toxicity and therapeutic efficacy of such agents can be determined by standard pharmaceutical procedures in cell cultures or experimental animals, e.g., for determining the LD50 (the dose lethal to 50% of the population) and the ED50 (the dose therapeutically effective in 50% of the population).
  • the dose ratio between toxic and therapeutic effects is the therapeutic index and can be expressed as the ratio LD50/ED50, and usually a larger therapeutic index is more efficacious. While compounds that exhibit toxic side effects may be used, care should be taken to design a delivery system that targets such agents to the site of affected tissue in order to minimize potential damage to unaffected cells and, thereby, reduce side effects.
  • doses depend upon a number of factors within the ken of the ordinarily skilled physician, veterinarian, or researcher.
  • the dose(s) of the small molecule will vary, for example, depending upon the identity, size, and condition of the subject or sample being treated, further depending upon the route by which the composition is to be administered, if applicable, and the effect which the practitioner desires the small molecule to have upon the subject.
  • Exemplary doses include milligram or microgram amounts of the small molecule per kilogram of subject or sample weight (e.g., about 1 microgram per kilogram to about 500 milligrams per kilogram, about 100 micrograms per kilogram to about 5 milligrams per kilogram, or about 1 microgram per kilogram to about 50 micrograms per kilogram).
  • appropriate doses depend upon the potency. Such appropriate doses may be determined using the assays known in the art. When one or more of these compounds is to be administered to an animal (e.g., a human), a physician, veterinarian, or researcher may, for example, prescribe a relatively low dose at first, subsequently increasing the dose until an appropriate response is obtained.
  • the specific dose level for any particular animal subject will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity of the specific compound employed, the age, body weight, general health, gender, and diet of the subject, the time of administration, the route of administration, the rate of excretion, and any drug combination.
  • doses may depend on the state of renal function in the subject, as measured, for example, by the rate of creatinine clearance, which may affect the rate of clearance of the compound from the subject.
  • rate of creatinine clearance which may affect the rate of clearance of the compound from the subject.
  • subjects with a lower rate of creatinine clearance would be expected to achieve a particular plasma concentration at a lower dose than those with a higher rate of creatinine clearance.
  • compositions may be formulated in dosage unit form for ease of administration and uniformity of dosage.
  • Dosage unit form refers to physically discrete units suited as unitary dosages for the subjects to be treated; each unit containing a predetermined quantity of compound of the invention calculated to produce the desired therapeutic effect in association with the required pharmaceutical vehicle.
  • the specification for the dosage unit forms of the invention are dictated by and directly dependent on (a) the unique characteristics of the therapeutic agent and the particular therapeutic effect to be achieved, and (b) the limitations inherent in the art of compounding such a compound of the invention for the treatment of AA amyloidosis or amyloid related disease.
  • the therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I) may be between about 100 and 2500 mg daily.
  • the compounds of the invention may be manufactured in capsules with dosages of 200 mg, 400 mg, or 800 mg of the compound of the invention.
  • the compounds of the invention may be administered with dosages of 400 mg BID, 800 mg BID, or 1200 mg BID.
  • a multicenter, multinational, randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled, and parallel-design study to assess the efficacy and safety of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt (PDS) in subjects having secondary (AA) amyloidosis is conducted.
  • a total of 183 subjects are randomized to receive either PDS or placebo twice daily for 24 months.
  • Dosing depends on the severity of renal impairment in a subject: subjects having creatinine clearance (ClCr)>80 mL/min receive 1200 mg BID; for ClCr between 30 and 80 mL/min, the subject receives 800 mg BID; and for ClCr between 20 and 30 mL/min and until the possible initiation of dialysis, the subject receives 400 mg BID.
  • ClCr decreases or increases to the next lower or higher range level
  • the dose regimen is adjusted accordingly.
  • Subject medication is administered orally (capsule).
  • Each patient is evaluated on 16 occasions, including on-site visits at months 0 (baseline), 1, 4, 8, 12, 16, 20 and 24.
  • ClCr urine ⁇ ⁇ creatinine ⁇ ⁇ ( mg ⁇ / ⁇ dl ) ⁇ urine ⁇ ⁇ volume ⁇ ⁇ ( ml ) serum ⁇ ⁇ creatinine ⁇ ⁇ ( mg ⁇ / ⁇ dl ) ⁇ time ⁇ ⁇ ( min )
  • the creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area is calculated by dividing the creatinine clearance by the body surface area.
  • Body surface area is calculated with the following equation: Wt 0.425 ⁇ Ht 0.725 ⁇ 0.007184 (DuBois D, Clinical Calorimetry, Arch Intern Med 1916; 17:87).
  • the “Safety population” will be the set of all subjects randomized to a treatment group who took at least one dose of the study drug (PDS). Subjects who were randomized during the screening period but did not meet one of the inclusion criteria at baseline and therefore did not take PDS will not be included in the Safety population.
  • the “Intent-to-Treat (ITT) population” will consist of the Safety population, i.e., all subjects who are randomized and who have taken any amount of PDS.
  • the “Efficacy Evaluable (per protocol; PP) population” will be a subset of the ITT subjects. It will consist of all subjects who complete the treatment period and can be assessed for the primary efficacy endpoint.
  • ACE angiotensin converting enzyme
  • CMH row mean scores test For the primary endpoint using the CMH row mean scores test, summary statistics, such as the number and the percentage of patients who reach each category of this composite assessment at the end of the study are to be presented by treatment group. Since the response levels may not necessarily be viewed as equally spaced but have a clear ordering, the modified ridit scores option is to be used. This scoring method requires no scaling of the response levels other than that implied by their relative ordering.
  • the CMH test statistic is not to be stratified by center because of the large number (27) of investigative sites relative to the sample size. The center effect is therefore to be investigated using only descriptive statistical methods. The country effect is also to be investigated descriptively.
  • the association between treatment and the composite endpoint can be adjusted for several Baseline variables, but to allow comparisons to the CMH test methodology, only the nephrotic status at Baseline (nephrotic vs non-nephrotic) is to be used initially for adjustments.
  • Other variables which could be included in other analyses using the Cox model are: treatment groups, age, Baseline CrCl, Baseline proteinuria, Baseline SCr, and underlying disease (familial Mediterranean fever, rheumatic inflammatory diseases, and miscellaneous).
  • the primary efficacy endpoint is a composite assessment of clinical improvement/worsening of renal function.
  • the subjects are classified into three categories, “Worse” and death (all causes), “Stable”, or “Improved”.
  • the subjects are classified as “worse” if at least one of the following clinical milestones of worsening is met: doubling of serum creatinine from baseline to Month 24; 50% or greater decrease in creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area from baseline to End of Study; progression to dialysis/ESRD; or death.
  • the subjects are classified as “stable” if none of the clinical milestones of worsening or improvement are met.
  • the subjects are classified as “improved” if the following clinical milestones of improvement are met: a 50% or greater increase in creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area from baseline to End of Study; and no clinical milestones of worsening.
  • End of Study is defined as Month 24 for subjects who completed the study and as the last available measurement for the subjects who discontinued early.
  • the secondary efficacy endpoints are an assessment of clinical improvement/worsening of both renal and gastrointestinal functions. At the end of the study, subjects are classified into three categories based on their condition: worse, stable, or improved. Examples of secondary efficacy endpoints include 1) the slope of creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area over time; 2) the slope in the reciprocal of serum creatinine (1/serum creatinine) over time; 3) time to renal events (e.g., such as, time to doubling of serum creatinine; time to ⁇ 50% increase in creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area; time to ⁇ 50% decrease in creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area; time to dialysis/ESRD; and/or time to death); and 4) changes from baseline to End of Study in proteinuria and creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area.
  • time to renal events e.g., such as, time to doubling of serum creatinine; time to ⁇ 50% increase in creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area;
  • summary statistics such as the number of observation (n), mean, SD, median, minimum, and maximum values, are displayed by treatment group at each evaluation visit.
  • the actual value and percent change from Baseline are also presented by treatment group at each evaluation visit.
  • treatment groups are compared using a two-way analysis of covariance (ANCOVA), controlling for Baseline and renal status at Baseline.
  • ANCOVA two-way analysis of covariance
  • the initial full model to be tested will be:
  • the two interaction terms will be dropped from the primary model if the test for their respective significance results in p-values greater than 10%.
  • the primary test for treatment difference will be then done using the resultant model. If the assumptions underlying the ANCOVA model are not satisfied, then a rank transformation approach (Inman and Conover) will be used. Following the Iman and Conover procedure, the entire set of observations are ranked from smallest to largest, with the smallest observation having rank 1, the second smallest rank 2, and so on. In case of ties, average ranks will be used. Following the appropriate transformation, the procedure ANCOVA model without the baseline covariate will be applied to the transformed data in a manner similar to that described above.
  • CSH Cochran-Mantel-Haenszel
  • the slope of creatinine clearance over time is commonly used clinically by nephrologists to predict long-term renal outcome and time to ESRD.
  • a negative slope indicates a loss of renal function. The more negative the slope, the faster the loss of renal function.
  • Creatinine clearance is assessed at the Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 visits through a 24 hr urine collection at each time point. This parameter will be normalized for body surface area and the least-squares estimate of the within-subject slope will be calculated using all available creatinine clearance measurements. Although the study is for 2 years, the slope will be expressed as an annual rate of change. If the data exhibits a nonlinear change over time, then a suitable transformation (i.e. log transformation) will be applied prior to the slope calculation.
  • a suitable transformation i.e. log transformation
  • Serum creatinine is assessed at the Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 visits.
  • the least-squares estimate of the within-subject slope will be calculated using all available serum creatinine measurements. Although the study is for 2 years, the slope will be expressed as an annual rate of change. If the data exhibits a nonlinear change over time, then a suitable transformation (i.e. log transformation) will be applied prior to the slope calculation.
  • summary statistics such as survival Kaplan-Meier estimates with 99% CI, quartiles and median survival time are presented by the treatment group on the ITT population.
  • the 99% CI is based on the Greenwood variance formula.
  • the KM estimates is presented for the following time windows: day 0 to 112, day 113 to 224, day 225 to 336, day 337 to 448, day 449 to 560, and more than 560 days.
  • the two treatment groups are compared using the stratified log-rank test and the stratification factor is the renal status at Baseline (nephrotic vs. non-nephrotic).
  • Four groups are compared on a Kaplan-Meier plot to depict the time to event in each treatment group: baseline nephrotic (treated vs. untreated) and baseline non-nephrotic (treated vs. untreated).
  • Time to Double Serum Creatinine [ ( date ⁇ ⁇ of ⁇ ⁇ first ⁇ ⁇ event ⁇ ⁇ of ⁇ ⁇ doubled ⁇ ⁇ serum creatinine ⁇ ⁇ from ⁇ ⁇ Baseline - Baseline ⁇ ⁇ date ) + 1 ] 30.4375 Time to ⁇ 50% Increase/Decrease in Creatinine Clearance Normalized for Body Surface Area [ ( date ⁇ ⁇ of ⁇ ⁇ first ⁇ ⁇ event ⁇ ⁇ of ⁇ ⁇ ⁇ ⁇ 50 ⁇ % ⁇ ⁇ increase ⁇ / ⁇ decrease ⁇ ⁇ from Baseline ⁇ ⁇ in ⁇ ⁇ creatinine ⁇ ⁇ clearance ⁇ * - Baseline ⁇ ⁇ date ) + 1 ] 30.4375 Time to Dialysis/ESRD [ ( date ⁇ ⁇ of ⁇ ⁇ dialysis ⁇ / ⁇ ESRD - Baseline ⁇ ⁇ date ) + 1 ] 30.4375 Time to Death [ ( date ⁇ ⁇ of ⁇
  • Proteinuria, creatinine clearance, and serum creatinine are assessed at Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 visits. Change from baseline to End of Study in Proteinuria and Creatinine Clearance will be analyzed as a secondary efficacy endpoint. The End of Study is defined as Month 24 for subjects who completed and as the last available visit for subjects who discontinued early.
  • proteinuria, creatinine clearance, and serum creatinine are to be collected from two distinct assessments which are to have been at least 1 week apart and within 3 months prior to study entry (Baseline visit). For the creatinine clearance parameter, the normalized value will be used.
  • Proteinuria, creatinine clearance, serum creatinine, serum albumin and serum alkaline phosphatase are assessed at Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20 (except for serum albumin and serum alkaline phosphatase), and 24 visits. At. Screening, proteinuria, creatinine clearance and serum creatinine are to have been collected from two distinct assessments which had to be at least 1 week apart and within 3 months prior to study entry.
  • SCr serum creatinine
  • both the value and its reciprocal, i.e., 1/SCr will be analyzed.
  • the normalized value will be used. Summary statistics of the actual value of each of these parameters will be presented by treatment group at each visit on the ITT population. Summary statistics will also be provided for the change from Baseline and the percent change from Baseline at each post-Baseline assessment for each of these parameters.
  • Nephrotic syndrome is defined in this example as heavy proteinuria (urinary protein >3 g/24 hr) associated with the two following extrarenal features: 1) hypoalbuminemia (serum albumin ⁇ 3.4 g/dL) and 2) peripheral edema by physical examination and/or use of diuretics to treat edema.
  • heavy proteinuria urinary protein >3 g/24 hr
  • hypoalbuminemia serum albumin ⁇ 3.4 g/dL
  • peripheral edema by physical examination and/or use of diuretics to treat edema.
  • Progression to nephrotic syndrome in subjects without nephrotic syndrome at baseline is defined as follows: an increase in proteinuria to >3 g/24 hr (needs to be ⁇ 3 g/24 hr at Baseline) and occurrence of the two following extrarenal features: 1) hypoalbuminemia (not present at Baseline) and 2) edema and/or use of diuretics to treat edema (no edema and no use of diuretics at Baseline). If subjects do not meet all three criteria at the end of the study, they will not be considered nephrotic for the purpose of the study analysis.
  • Remission of nephrotic syndrome in subjects with nephrotic syndrome at baseline is defined as follows: a decrease in proteinuria to ⁇ 1 g/24 h (needs to be >3 g/24 hr at Baseline) and an improvement in one of the two following extrarenal features: 1) increase in serum albumin to 3.4 g/dL (if scrum albumin ⁇ 3.4 g/dL at Baseline or at any other time during the study) or 2) resolution of edema and/or discontinuation of diuretics in response to improvement in edema (if edema was a presenting symptom or if a patient used diuretics at Baseline or at any other time during the study).
  • the autonomic nervous system may be affected in AA amyloidosis.
  • a postural decrease in blood pressure is defined as a drop from the supine to standing position of ⁇ 20 mmHg in systolic blood pressure (SBP) or 10 mmHg in diastolic blood pressure (DBP). If the drop in systolic or diastolic blood pressure is sustained for at least 3 minutes, it is a sign of ANS dysfunction. Blood pressure is measured in the supine, standing, and standing-3-minutes-later positions at the Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 visits.
  • Descriptive statistics such as the number and the percentage of subjects in each category (yes vs. no) is presented by treatment group and at each study visit on the ITT population. Treatment groups are compared using a CMH general association test adjusted for the renal status at Baseline.
  • Splenomegaly is defined as an enlargement of the spleen. Spleen size will be measured by physical examination at Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20 and 24 visits. It is measured in centimeters from the left costal margin at then anterior axillary line, using a ruler. Measures are taken when the subject is lying down and at the end of inspiration.
  • Hepatomegaly is defined as an enlargement of the liver. Liver size will be measured by physical examination at Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20 and 24 visits. It is measured in centimeters from the right costal margin at the mid-clavicular line, using a ruler. Measures are taken when the patient is lying down and at the end of inspiration.
  • the safety, tolerability and pharmacokinetics of PDS following single oral administration in healthy male adult volunteers is determined.
  • the effect of food on the pharmacokinetics of PDS is also determined.
  • the first part of the study is a randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled study to assess the pharmacokinetic profile of 6 single rising oral doses of PDS in healthy male subjects.
  • the second part of this study is an open-label, two-way crossover study to investigate the effect of food on the pharmacokinetic profile of a single oral dose of PDS under fasted and fed conditions. Blood samples are collected during 36 hours following dosing. Plasma concentrations of PDS are determined using validated HPLC methods.
  • PDS is administered as a single oral dose to healthy male subjects at 400, 800 and 1600 mg on Days 1 and 7. Following the single oral administration on Day 1, PDS is administered on Days 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6 at 400, 800 and 1600 mg four times daily, or 1600 mg three times daily. Blood samples are collected through 24 hours after the dose on Day 1, before the first and last doses on Days 2 through 6, and after 48 hours after the final dose on Day 7. Plasma concentrations of PDS are determined using validated HPLC methods.
  • T 1/2 mean half-life
  • AUC 0-t and C max extent of systemic exposure
  • PDS is administered as a single oral dose for a subset of AA amyloidosis patients on Month 0 and 24 visits. Following the single administration on Month 0, PDS is administered twice daily for 24 months. Blood samples are collected through 24 hours after the doses on Month 0 and 24, and through 8 hours after the doses on Month 4, 8, 12 visits. Plasma concentrations of PDS are determined using validated HPLC methods. Following multiple dose oral administration of PDS, the range of accumulation across subjects is 1.75 to 3.44. Based on the accumulation factor, the mean T 1/2 calculated is 15 hours with a range of 10 to 24 hours. Results are shown in Table 6.
  • Capsules of 400 mgs of 1,3 propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt are manufactured by filling #0 white opaque hard gelatin capsules with a white powder comprised of 400 mg of 1,3 propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt and 40 mg of excipients.
  • a pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 1,2-ethanedisulfonic acid as the active agent.
  • a pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with sodium 1,2-ethanedisulfonate as the active agent.
  • a pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 1,2-ethanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate) as the active agent.
  • a pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 1,2-ethanediol disulfate disodium salt as the active agent.
  • a pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 1,3-propanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate) as the active agent.
  • a pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 1,3-propanediol disulfate disodium salt as the active agent.
  • a pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 2-sulfomethyl-1,4-butanedisulfonic acid as the active agent.
  • a pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 2-sulfomethylbutane-1,4-disulfonic acid trisodium salt as the active agent.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Neurology (AREA)
  • Neurosurgery (AREA)
  • Biomedical Technology (AREA)
  • Emergency Medicine (AREA)
  • Oncology (AREA)
  • Communicable Diseases (AREA)
  • Hospice & Palliative Care (AREA)
  • Psychiatry (AREA)
  • Urology & Nephrology (AREA)
  • Rheumatology (AREA)
  • Pain & Pain Management (AREA)
  • Acyclic And Carbocyclic Compounds In Medicinal Compositions (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)
  • Agricultural Chemicals And Associated Chemicals (AREA)
  • Organic Low-Molecular-Weight Compounds And Preparation Thereof (AREA)
  • Medicinal Preparation (AREA)

Abstract

Methods, formulations, and compositions for the treatment of amyloidosis are described.

Description

    RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • This application is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 11/405,348 filed Apr. 17, 2006, which claims the benefit Under 35 U.S.C. §119(e) of U.S. Provisional Application No. 60/671,866, filed Apr. 15, 2005, which are incorporated herein by reference in their entireties and for all purposes.
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • Amyloidosis is the generic term for a number of diseases related by extracellular deposition of insoluble fibrillar proteins (amyloid) in specific organs, which eventually leads to the failure of the involved organs. R. H. Falk et al, The Systemic Amyloidosis, 337 N ENGL J MED 898-909 (1997), P. N. Hawkins, Amyloidosis, 9 BLOOD REV 135-42 (1995), J. D. Sipe, Amyloidosis, 31 CR REV CE1N LAB SC 1325-54 (1994); A. S. Cohen, Amyloidosis, 40(2) BULL RHEUM DISEASES 1-12 (1991). Amyloid deposits can remain limited to one organ (localized amyloidosis) or may be more broadly distributed (systemic amyloidosis). Systemic amyloidoses are generally classified into four types based on the nature of the fibrillar deposits: (i.) idiopathic or primary amyloidosis (AL amyloidosis); (ii.) reactive, secondary or amyloid A (AA) amyloidosis; (iii.) familial amyloidotic polyneuropathy; and (iv.) dialysis-associated amyloidosis. Though diverse in their occurrence, all amyloid deposits have common morphologic properties, stain with specific dyes (e.g., Congo red), and have a characteristic birefringent appearance in polarized light after staining. They also share common ultrastructural features and common X-ray diffraction and infrared spectra.
  • AA amyloidosis is thought to be related to amyloid A (AA) protein formed from the precursor serum amyloid A (SAA), an acute phase protein produced and secreted by hepatocytes in response to inflammation. AA amyloidosis is associated with chronic inflammatory conditions (e.g. rheumatoid arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, inflammatory bowel disease, etc.), chronic infections (e.g., tuberculosis, osteomyelitis etc.), and hereditary fevers, e.g., Familial Mediterranean Fever (R. H. Falk et al., 337 N ENGL J MED 898-909 (1997), A. S. Cohen, 40(2) BULL RHEUM DISEASES 1-12 (1991), G. Grateau, 12 CURRENT OPINION IN RHEUMATOL 61-64 (2000)). Rheumatoid arthritis is the major cause of AA amyloidosis in Western Europe and North America (M. Skinner Amyloidosts, CURRENT THERAPY IN ALLERGY, IMMUNOLOGY, AND RHEUMATOLOGY 235-40 (Mosby-Year Book Inc., 1996), M. A. Gertz, Secondary amyloidosis, 232 J INT MED 517-18 (1992)).
  • AA amyloidosis mainly affects parenchymatous organs, such as, kidneys, spleen, liver, and adrenals. The most common clinical feature of AA amyloidosis is renal dysfunction manifested as nephrotic-range proteinuria or renal insufficiency at the time of diagnosis. End-stage renal failure is the cause of death in 40-60% of cases (M. Skinner Amyloidosis, CURRENT THERAPY IN ALLERGY, IMMUNOLOGY, AND RHEUMATOLOGY 235-40 (Mosby-Year Book Inc., 1996), M. A. Gertz, 232 J INT MED 517-18 (1992), M. A. Gertz and R. A. Kyle, 70 MEDICINE 246-256 (1991)). Gastrointestinal involvement is also frequent and is usually manifested as chronic diarrhea, body weight loss and malabsorption. Enlargement of the liver and spleen may also occur in some subjects. Cardiac involvement is rare and occurs late in the disease. The median survival time from diagnosis varies from 2 to 8 years depending on the stage of the disease at time of diagnosis (M. A. Gertz and R. A. Kyle, 70 MEDICINE 246-256 (1991)).
  • AA amyloidosis is usually seen associated with chronic infection (such as tuberculosis) or chronic inflammation (such as rheumatoid arthritis or hereditary fevers). A familial form of AA amyloidosis is seen Familial Mediterranean Fever (FMF). This familial type of amyloidosis is genetically inherited and is found in specific population groups. In both AL and AA amyloidosis, deposits are found in several organs and are thus considered systemic amyloid diseases.
  • “Localized amyloidoses” are those that tend to involve a single organ system. Different amyloids are also characterized by the type of protein present in the deposit. For example, neurodegenerative diseases such as scrapie, bovine spongiform encephalitis, Creutzfeldt-Jakob disease, and the like are characterized by the appearance and accumulation of a protease-resistant form of a prion protein (referred to as AScr or PrP-27) in the central nervous system. Similarly, Alzheimer's disease, another neurodegenerative disorder, is characterized by neuritic plaques and neurofibrillary tangles. In this case, the amyloid plaques found in the parenchyma and the blood vessel is formed by the deposition of fibrillar Aβ amyloid protein. Other diseases such as adult-onset diabetes (type II diabetes) are characterized by the localized accumulation of amyloid fibrils in the pancreas.
  • Once these amyloids have formed, there is no known, widely accepted therapy or treatment which significantly dissolves amyloid deposits in situ, prevents further amyloid deposition or prevents the initiation of amyloid deposition.
  • Each amyloidogenic protein has the ability to undergo a conformational change and to organize into β-sheets and form insoluble fibrils which may be deposited extracellularly or intracellularly. Each amyloidogenic protein, although different in amino acid sequence, has the same property of forming fibrils and binding to other elements such as proteoglycan, amyloid P and complement component. Moreover, each amyloidogenic protein has amino acid sequences which, although different, show similarities such as regions with the ability to bind to the glycosaminoglycan (GAG) portion of proteoglycan (referred to as the GAG binding site) as well as other regions which promote β-sheet formation. Proteoglycans are macromolecules of various sizes and structures that are distributed almost everywhere in the body. They can be found in the intracellular compartment, on the surface of cells, and as part of the extracellular matrix. The basic structure of all proteoglycans is comprised of a core protein and at least one, but frequently more, polysaccharide chains (GAGs) attached to the core protein. Many different GAGs have been discovered including chondroitin sulfate, dermatan sulfate, keratan sulfate, heparin, and hyaluronan.
  • Some GAG mimetics are known to be useful for inhibiting amyloid deposition and/or treating some forms of amyloidosis. See WO 94/22437, WO 96/28187, and WO 00/64420.
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • In one embodiment, the invention pertains to a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a target subject, by administering to the target subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the formula:

  • Y—(CH2)n—[CH2Y]m  (I)
  • wherein Y is SO3X or OSO3X independently chosen for each occurrence; X is cationic group independently chosen for each occurrence; n is 1, 2, 3 or 4; and m is 1 or 2, such that the AA amyloidosis is treated or prevented, while maintaining an acceptable tolerance index (ATI) for a parameter associated with renal impairment (PRI). Furthermore, in this embodiment, the target subject is being treated for AA amyloidosis and has or is susceptible to a parameter associated with renal impairment. In a further embodiment the compound of formula (I) is 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt.
  • In another embodiment, the invention includes a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a target subject, by administering to the target subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the AA amyloidosis is treated or prevented while maintaining an acceptable tolerance index (ATI) for a parameter associated with gastrointestinal impairment (PGI). Furthermore, in this embodiment, the target subject is being treated for AA amyloidosis and has or is susceptible to a parameter associated with gastrointestinal impairment.
  • In another further embodiment, the invention also pertains to a method of treating or preventing an amyloid related disease in a subject by administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, at a dosage selected based upon creatinine clearance rate, such that the amyloid related disease is treated or prevented.
  • The invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method for treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a subject, by administering to the subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, which is administered in a dosage, such that an effective exposure is provided in a subject, for example, as measured by, e.g., AUC, Cmax, AUCss, Css, Tmax, etc.
  • In addition, the invention also pertains to a method of stabilizing or improving renal and/or gastrointestinal function in a subject. The method includes administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains to a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a subject. The method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent such that AA amyloidosis is treated or prevented.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of increasing the oral bioavailability of a compound in a subject, by administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in a pharmaceutical composition without food such that the oral bioavailability of the compound in the subject is increased.
  • The invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating an inflammatory disease in a subject, by administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent such that said inflammatory disease is treated in the subject.
  • The invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating a hereditary fever in a subject, by administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent such that said hereditary fever is treated in the subject.
  • The invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method for treating rheumatoid arthritis in a subject. The method includes administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent.
  • In addition, the invention also includes a method of treating a malignant neoplasm in a subject. The method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent such that the malignant neoplasm is treated in the subject.
  • In a further embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating a chronic infection, e.g., microbial or viral, in a subject. The method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a second agent such that the chronic infection is treated in the subject.
  • In another further embodiment, the invention pertains at least in part to method of stabilizing or improving renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having an inflammatory disorder, a malignant neoplasm, a chronic infection or a hereditary fever. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, such that renal function is stabilized or improved or progression of renal disease is delayed.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for preventing or delaying progression to ESRD/dialysis in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject, e.g., a subject having AA amyloidosis, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that progression to ESRD/dialysis is delayed or prevented.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for preventing or delaying the time to the doubling of serum creatinine in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound, of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the time to the doubling of serum creatinine is delayed or prevented.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for preventing or delaying the time to at least a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the time to the at least a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is delayed or prevented.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for decreasing the time to at least a 50% increase in creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the time to the at least 50% increase in creatinine clearance is decreased.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention includes a method for reducing the rate of progression of renal disease as measured by the slope of creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the rate of progression of renal disease is reduced.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for stabilizing or reducing proteinuria in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the proteinuria in said subject is stabilized or reduced.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention includes a method for stabilizing renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that renal function is stabilized or progression of renal disease is delayed. In one aspect, progression of renal disease may be measured by a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance (CrCI), doubling of serum creatinine (SCr), and/or progression to ESRD.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for treating renal impairment in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the renal impairment is treated.
  • The invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, and a second agent.
  • In a further embodiment, the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition. The packaged pharmaceutical composition includes a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, packaged in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered in combination with a second agent.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition, which includes a therapeutically effective amount of a second agent packaged in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered in combination with a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition, which includes a container holding a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered without food.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation for treating AA amyloidosis. The formulation comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, in a formulation, wherein the formulation has at least one favorable biological property (FBP) upon administration to the subject.
  • The invention also pertains, at least in part, to an anti-amyloidogenic agent in a formulation, wherein the anti-amyloidogenic agent-containing formulation is equivalent to a standard formulation predetermined to have at least one favorable biological property upon administration to a subject such that it is a biologically favorable formulation.
  • In another embodiment, the invention also includes a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprising a compound of formula (I), and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. In this embodiment, the pharmaceutical formulation, when administered once to a subject in need thereof, provides a Cmax of about 200 to about 2000 ng/mL.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising a compound of formula (I), and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. In this embodiment, the pharmaceutical formulation, when administered to a subject in need thereof, provides an AUCabout 2,000 to about 44,000 ng/mL.
  • The invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method of administering a compound to a subject in need thereof. The method includes administering a compound of formula (I) to the subject in an amount sufficient to achieve a Cmax of about 200 to about 3,400 ng/mL. The Cmax may occur about 0.25 to about 9.00 hours after administration.
  • In another embodiment, the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method of administering a compound of formula (I) to a subject in need thereof. The method includes administering a compound of formula (I) to the subject in an amount sufficient to achieve an AUC of about 2,000 to about 44,000 ng/mL.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises a 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. The pharmaceutical formulation provides a Cmax of about 200 to about 2000 ng/mL, when administered once to a subject in need thereof.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention also includes a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers. The pharmaceutical formulation provides a AUC of about 2,000 to about 44,000 ng/mL, when administered to a subject in need thereof.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention also pertains to a method of administering 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof to a subject in need thereof. The method includes administering 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof to a subject in an amount sufficient to achieve a Cmax of about 200 to about 3,400 ng/mL about 0.25 to about 9.00 hours after administration.
  • In another embodiment, the invention also pertains to a method of administering 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof to a subject in need thereof, by administering 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof to the subject in an amount sufficient to achieve an AUC of about 2,000 to about 44,000 ng/mL.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation. The pharmaceutical formulation comprises an active agent (e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid, disodium salt (also referred to as PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about from 2900 to about 9000 ng·h/mL±20% and a mean Cmax of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of from about 2,900 to about 9,000 ng·h/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean Cmax of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of less than about 30 ml/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 10,000-12,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-900 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of about 30 to about 80 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 9,000-10,500 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cma, of about 750-875 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1200 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of greater than about 80 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 5,000-6,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-925 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising 800 mgs of an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject: when said subject is healthy, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 4,000-6,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 1,200-1,300 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the subject has mild renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 12,000-14,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,500-3,500 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the subject has moderate renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 9,000-11,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,000-2,200 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the subject has severe renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 40,000-46,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,100-2,300 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis for twenty-four months: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 25,000-26,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,000-2,300 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 20,000-22,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 1,600-2,000 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1200 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 8,000-10,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-1,000 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to healthy male subjects for seven days: in a dose of 400 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 10,000-11,500 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 900-1100 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 19,000-21,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 1,600-1,800 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1600 mg TID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 25,000-27,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 4,000-6,000 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1600 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 23,000-25,500 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 4,500-6,500 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention also pertains to a method of stabilizing or improving renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes orally administering a formulation comprising 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, in an amount determined in accordance with the subject's rate of creatinine clearance. For example, when the formulation is administered in a dose of 400 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid having a mean AUC of about 10,000-12,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-900 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 800 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 9,000-10,500 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax about 750-875 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 1200 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 5,000-6,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-925 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. Furthermore, when this formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of less than about 30 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 6,000-17,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 500-1200 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of from about 30 to about 80 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 3000-20000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 300-1200 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1200 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of greater than about 80 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 2,000-11,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 400-1500 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a method of stabilizing or improving renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having AA amyloidosis, comprising orally administering a formulation comprising 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, in an amount determined in accordance with the subject's rate of creatinine clearance. Furthermore, when the formulation is administered in a dose of 400 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid having a mean AUC of about 6,000-17,000 ng·h/mL 20%, and a mean Cmax of about 500-1200 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 800 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 3000-20000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 300-1200 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 1200 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 2,000-11,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 400-1500 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
  • FIG. 1 is a graph depicting a Kaplan-Meier curve for the time to the first “worse” event for subjects administered PDS versus a placebo.
  • FIG. 2 is a line graph showing the slope of creatinine clearance for subjects administered PDS versus a placebo.
  • FIG. 3 is a graph depicting a Kaplan-Meier curve for the time to a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance for subjects administered PDS versus a placebo.
  • FIG. 4 is a graph depicting a Kaplan-Meier curve for the time to ESRD/Dialysis for subjects administered PDS versus a placebo.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION A. Methods of Treating a Target Subject Using Compounds of the Invention
  • In one embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a target subject who is being treated for AA amyloidosis and has or is susceptible to a parameter associated with renal impairment. The method includes administering to the target subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the formula:

  • Y—(CH2)n—[CH2Y]m  (I)
  • wherein Y is SO3X or OSO3X independently chosen for each occurrence; X is cationic group independently chosen for each occurrence; n is 1, 2, 3 or 4; and m is 1 or 2, such that AA amyloidosis is treated or prevented while maintaining an acceptable tolerance index (ATI) for a parameter associated with renal impairment (PRI).
  • In another embodiment, the invention includes a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a target subject, who is being treated for AA amyloidosis and has or is susceptible to a secondary disorder or state associated with gastrointestinal impairment. The method includes administering to the target subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), while maintaining an acceptable tolerance index (All) for a parameter associated with gastrointestinal impairment (PGI).
  • Generally, AA amyloidosis is a manifestation of a number of diseases that provoke a sustained acute phase response. Such diseases include chronic inflammatory disorders, chronic local or systemic microbial infections, and malignant neoplasms. The most common form of reactive or secondary (AA) amyloidosis is seen as the result of long-standing inflammatory conditions. For example, subjects with Rheumatoid Arthritis or Familial Mediterranean Fever (which is a genetic disease) can develop AA amyloidosis. The terms “AA amyloidosis,” “secondary amyloidosis” and “secondary (AA) amyloidosis” are used interchangeably.
  • AA fibrils are generally composed of 8,000 Dalton fragments (AA peptide or protein) formed by proteolytic cleavage of serum amyloid A protein (ApoSAA), a circulating apolipoprotein which is mainly synthesized in hepatocytes in response to such cytokines as IL-1, IL-6 and TNF. Once secreted, ApoSAA is complexed with HDL. Deposition of AA fibrils can be widespread in the body, with a preference for parenchymal organs. The kidneys are usually a deposition site, and the liver and the spleen may also be affected. Deposition is also seen in the heart, gastrointestinal tract, and the skin.
  • Underlying diseases which can lead to the development of AA amyloidosis include, but are not limited to, inflammatory diseases, such as chronic inflammatory disease, rheumatoid arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriasis, psoriatic arthropathy, Reiter's syndrome, Adult Still's disease, Behcet's syndrome, familial Mediterranean fever, inflammatory bowel disease, hereditary periodic fevers, juvenile chronic arthritis, juvenile rheumatoid arthritis, ulcerative colitis, chronic fevers, bronchiostasis, malaria, vasculitis, IV drug use, psoriatic arthritis, lupus erythematosus arthritis, periarthritis nodosa, Wegner's granulomatosis, Muckle-Wells syndrome and Crohn's disease. AA deposits are also produced as a result of chronic infections, e.g., AIDS, HIV, hepatitis B, hepatitis C, chronic microbial infections, e.g., leprosy, tuberculosis, bronchiectasis, decubitus ulcers, pyelonephritis, osteomyelitis, acne conglobata, common variable immunodeficiency, hypolagammaglobulinemia, cystic fibrosis, pulmonary tuberculosis, pulmonary infection(s), recurrent abscesses, Behcet's disease, and Whipple's disease. Certain malignant neoplasms can also result in AA fibril amyloid deposits. These include such conditions as Hodgkin's lymphoma, renal carcinoma, carcinomas of gut, lung and urogenital tract, basal cell carcinoma, hepatoma, Castleman's disease, Schnitzler's syndrome, Waldenstrom's disease, and hairy cell leukemia.
  • The term “subject” includes living organisms in which AA amyloidosis or an amyloid related disease can occur, or which are susceptible to AA amyloidosis or amyloid related diseases. The term “subject” includes animals (e.g., mammals, e.g., cats, dogs, horses, pigs, cows, goats, sheep, rodents, e.g., mice or rats, rabbits, squirrels, bears, primates (e.g., chimpanzees, monkeys, gorillas, and humans)), as well as chickens, ducks, peking ducks, geese, and transgenic species thereof.
  • The term “target subject,” refers to a subject, e.g., a human, specifically chosen to receive the compositions or compounds of formula (I). Accordingly, in some embodiments, target subjects include subjects who are at risk of or have been diagnosed with an AA amyloid related disease, e.g., AA amyloidosis. Subjects at risk of developing AA amyloidosis include those with an underlying disease, such as an inflammatory disease, infection, hereditary fever or neoplasm. In other embodiments, target subjects include subjects that have or are susceptible to a parameter associated with renal impairment and/or gastrointestinal impairment. Target subjects also may include subjects who have been diagnosed with both an AA amyloid related disease and are known to have a parameter associated with renal impairment and/or gastrointestinal impairment. The preferred target subject is a human.
  • The terms “Acceptable Tolerance Index” and “ATI” are used interchangeably to refer to a level of illness in a subject that is considered satisfactory at a given time point in the disease or disorder afflicting the subject. In some embodiments, an ATI is an improvement or stabilization of the illness in a subject, as described herein. In other embodiments, an ATI is less worsening of an illness in a subject, as compared to a previous time point, e.g., when a subject is experiencing a rapid increase in serum creatinine levels, an ATI may be a slower increase in serum creatinine levels. Accordingly, in one embodiment, an ATI is less worsening in a subject of at least one of the parameters associated with renal impairment or gastrointestinal impairment. In another embodiment, an ATI is less worsening in a subject of at least two of the parameters associated with renal impairment and/or gastrointestinal impairment. In still another embodiment, an ATI is less worsening in a subject of at least three, four or five of the parameters associated with renal impairment and/or gastrointestinal impairment.
  • The terms “parameter associated with renal impairment,” and “PRI” are used interchangeably to include parameters generally associated with abnormal kidney function, such as, but not limited to decreased creatinine clearance, increased levels of serum creatinine, proteinuria, progression to dialysis/End Stage Renal Disease (ESRD), hypoalbuminemia, and/or edema. In some embodiments, the parameter associated with renal impairment is caused, at least in part, by AA amyloidosis or the presence of amyloid A protein in the body.
  • The terms “parameter associated with gastrointestinal impairment,” and “PGI” include parameters generally associated with abnormal gastrointestinal function, such as, but not limited to, chronic diarrhea and/or loss of body weight. In some embodiments, the parameter associated with gastrointestinal impairment is caused, at least in part, by AA amyloidosis or the presence of amyloid A protein in the body.
  • The terms “treatment” or “treating” of a subject includes the application or administration of a compound of the invention to a subject (or application or administration of a compound of the invention to a cell or tissue from a subject) with the purpose of stabilizing, curing, healing, alleviating, relieving, altering, remedying, less worsening, ameliorating, improving, or affecting the disease or condition, the symptom of the disease or condition, or the risk of (or susceptibility to) the disease or condition. The term “treating” refers to any indicia of success in the treatment or amelioration of an injury, pathology or condition, including any objective or subjective parameter such as abatement; remission; lessening of the rate of worsening; stabilization, diminishing of symptoms or making the injury, pathology or condition more tolerable to the subject; slowing in the rate of degeneration or decline; making the final point of degeneration less debilitating; or improving a subject's physical or mental well-being. In an embodiment, the term “treating” can include increasing a subject's life expectancy.
  • The term “remission of chronic diarrhea” refers to no episodes of chronic diarrhea and no chronic use of antidiarrheal agents for at least four consecutive months.
  • In one embodiment, the progression to dialysis is delayed or prevented in a subject, e.g., a subject having AA amyloidosis. For example, a subject's progression to dialysis may be delayed by 1 month or longer, 2 months or longer, 3 months or longer, 4 months or longer, 5 months or longer, 6 months or longer, 7 months or longer, 8 months or longer, 10 months or longer, 11 months or longer, 1 year or longer, 1.5 years or longer, 2 years or longer, 3 years or longer, 4 years or longer, 5 years or longer, 7.5 years or longer, 10 years or longer, 15 years or longer, or 20 years or longer. In a particular embodiment, it is delayed by about 6 months.
  • In another embodiment, the term “treating” includes decreasing the risk of any “worse” event of renal decline (see Example 3) or all-cause mortality by at least 5% or greater, at least 10% or greater, at least 15% or greater, at least 20% or greater, at least 30% or greater, at least 40% or greater, at least 50% or greater, at least 60% or greater, or at least 63% or greater. In another embodiment, the risk of any “worse” event of renal decline or all-cause mortality is decreased 7%-63%.
  • In another embodiment, the term “treating” also includes increasing the mean time to the first “worse” event. The increase may be about 0.5 months or longer, about 1 month or longer, about 2 months or longer, about 3 months or longer, about 4 months or longer, about 5 months or longer, about 6 months or longer, about 7 months or longer, about 8 months or longer, about 9 months or longer, about 10 months or longer, or about 11 months or longer. In another embodiment, the time is increased by about: 2.8 months±7.5 months longer in PDS treated subjects.
  • In another embodiment, the subject's creatinine clearance rate is stabilized or improved. For example, a subject's creatinine clearance rate may be increased by about 10% or greater, by about 20% or greater, by about 30% or greater, by about 40% or greater, by about 50% or greater, by about 60% or greater, by about 70% or greater, by about 80% or greater, by about 90% or greater, or by about 100% or greater as compared to the subject's level prior to treatment with the compounds of the invention.
  • In another embodiment, the risk of a 50% or greater decrease in creatinine clearance is reduced at least about 5% or more, at least about 10% or more, at least about 15% or more, or at least about 18% or more. In a further embodiment, the risk of a 50% or greater decrease in creatinine clearance is reduced about 18% to 72%.
  • In another embodiment, a subject's serum creatinine, serum albumin levels, and/or serum alkaline phosphatase levels are stabilized or improved. For example, a subject's serum creatinine, serum albumin levels, and/or serum alkaline phosphatase levels may be increased by about 10% or greater, by about 20% or greater, by about 30% or greater, by about 40% or greater, by about 50% or greater, by about 60% or greater, by about 70% or greater, by about 80% or greater, by about 90% or greater, or by about 100% or greater as compared to the subject's level prior to treatment with the compounds of the invention.
  • In a further embodiment, the risk of the doubling of serum creatinine is reduced by at least 5% or greater, at least 10% or greater, at least 11% or greater, at least 12% or greater, at least 13% or greater, or at least 14% or greater. In a further embodiment, a subject's risk of having their serum creatinine is double is reduced from about 14% to about 81%.
  • In another embodiment, the term “treating” also includes increasing the mean time to the doubling of serum creatinine. The increase may be about 0.5 months or longer, about 1 month or longer, about 2 months or longer, about 3 months or longer, about 4 months or longer, about 5 months or longer, about 6 months or longer, about 7 months or longer, about 8 months or longer, about 9 months or longer, about 10 months or longer, about 11 months or longer, or about a year or longer.
  • In another embodiment, a subject's proteinuria levels, visceral amyloid burden, and/or amyloid content in aspirated fat tissue are stabilized or improved. For example, a subject's proteinuria levels, visceral amyloid burden, and/or amyloid content in aspirated fat tissue may be reduced by about 10% or greater, by about 20% or greater, by about 30% or greater, by about 40% or greater, by about 50% or greater, by about 60% or greater, by about 70% or greater, by about 80% or greater, by about 90% or greater, or by about 100% or greater as compared to the subject's level prior to treatment with the compounds of the invention.
  • In another embodiment, a subject's visceral amyloid burden is reduced or stabilized. A subject's visceral amyloid burden can be assessed by, for example, using 123I-radiolabeled serum amyloid P component (SAP) scintigraphy. SAP binds specifically to amyloid fibrils and is retained in tissue amyloid deposits for prolonged periods, apparently protected from the normal rapid catabolism to which it is subject in the circulation. Scintigraphic imaging with radiolabeled SAP has been developed as a specific noninvasive method for assessing visceral amyloid burden (Hawkins P N et al. N Engl J Med, 1990; 323:508-13). Visceral amyloid burden can be quantified, for example, by visual assessment of whole body scintigraphs obtained 24 hours after the injection of the radionuclide.
  • In another embodiment, a subject's amyloid content in aspirated fat tissue is reduced or stabilized. The term “amyloid content in aspirated fat tissue” refers to the content of amyloid A in aspirated fat tissue. Changes in amyloid A content in aspirated fat tissue can be measured semi-quantitatively by Congo red staining. Amyloid A content in fat tissue can be measured quantitatively, for example, by using a monoclonal antibody-based sandwich ELISA using fat tissue collected from a subject. (Hazenberg B et al. Ann Rheum Dis, 1999; 58: 96-102).
  • The term “orthostatic hypotension” refers to a sudden fall in blood pressure that occurs when a person assumes a standing position. Symptoms, which generally occur after sudden standing, include dizziness, lightheadedness, blurred vision, and syncope (temporary loss of consciousness). The autonomic nervous system (ANS) is sometimes affected in AA amyloidosis. A postural decrease in blood pressure (e.g. a drop from the supine to standing position of 20 mmHg in systolic blood pressure or 10 mmHg in diastolic blood pressure sustained for at least 3 min) is a sign of ANS dysfunction.
  • In another embodiment, a subject's body weight loss is improved or stabilized, or the subject gains weight. For example, a subject might gain 5% or more, about 10% or more, about 20% or more, about 30% or more, about 40% or more, about 50% or more, or about 60% or more of their body weight prior to treatment with the compounds of the invention.
  • In another embodiment a subject's nephrotic syndrome may be stabilized or go into remission. In another embodiment, a subject's edema may be resolved or alleviated. In another embodiment, the stabilization, improvement, cure, or remission of diarrhea in a subject may occur. In yet another embodiment, there may be stabilization or reduction of orthostatic hypotension, splenomegaly, and/or hepatomegaly in a subject.
  • In one embodiment, remission of nephrotic syndrome includes a decrease in proteinuria to ≦1 g/24 h and either an increase in serum albumin to greater than 3.4 g/dL or resolution of an edema and/or discontinuation of diuretics in response to improvement in edema.
  • The term “therapeutically effective amount” refers to the amount of a compound which is effective to treat a subject, e.g., treat a subject for AA amyloidosis or an amyloid related disease or treat a subject having an underlying disease, such as, but not limited to, an inflammatory disorder, a malignant neoplasm, or chronic microbial infection. The therapeutically effective amount may vary based on the particular disorder(s) the subject is suffering from, the age, weight, and lifestyle of a particular subject. In addition, the therapeutically effective amount may depend on the seventy of the disease state, organ function, kidney function, or underlying disease (e.g., the subject may be suffering from an inflammatory disease, a malignant neoplasm, a chronic infection). In an embodiment, the subject is nephrotic. In another embodiment, the subject is non-nephrotic.
  • The term “nephrotic” refers to a subject suffering from nephrotic syndrome. Nephrotic syndrome is generally defined as heavy proteinuria (e.g., urinary protein >3 g/24 h) in combination with the two following extrarenal features 1) hypoalbuminemia (e.g., serum albumin <3.4 g/dL); and 2) a peripheral edema by physical examination and/or use of diuretics to treat edema.
  • The term “non-nephrotic” refers to a subject who has not yet progressed to nephrotic syndrome or who is in remission of nephrotic syndrome. Remission of nephrotic syndrome is a decrease in proteinuria to ≦1 g/24 h and an improvement in one of the two following extrarenal features: 1) increase in serum albumin to 3.4 g/dL or 2) resolution of edema and/or discontinuation of diuretics in response to improvement in edema. Progression to nephrotic syndrome is an increase in proteinuria to >3 g/24 h and occurrence of the two following extrarenal features: 1) hypoalbuminemia (serum albumin <3.4 g/dL) and 2) edema and/or use of diuretics to treat edema.
  • In another further embodiment, the invention also pertains to a method of treating or preventing amyloid related disease in a subject by administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) at a dosage selected based upon the subject's creatinine clearance rate, proteinuria level, and/or serum albumin levels.
  • The term “creatinine clearance” is art recognized and refers to the rate at which the kidneys clear creatinine from the blood. Creatinine is a substance that is easily excreted by the kidney in healthy subjects. Creatinine clearance generally compares the level of creatinine in urine with the creatinine level in the blood. Clearance is often measured as milliliters/minute (ml/min).
  • The dosage administered in the methods of the present invention may be selected based upon creatinine clearance rate. For example, the dosage of the compound of formula (I) may be selected to be about 1200 mg twice daily for a creatinine clearance rate of >80 mL/min. For a creatinine clearance rate of between about 30 and 80 mL/min, the dosage of the compound of formula (I) may be selected to be about 800 mg twice daily. For a creatinine clearance rate of between about 20 and 30 mL/min, the dosage of the compound of formula (I) may be selected to be about 400 mg twice daily. In addition, the dosage also may be adjusted based on the changing creatinine clearance rates in the subject.
  • In one embodiment, the dosage may be selected such that desired pharmacokinetic parameters and/or biologically favorable parameters are obtained after administration of the compound of the invention to the subject. In one embodiment, the dosage is selected such that once administered to the subject, the mean AUCss in the subject is about 7,000 to about 26,000 ng·h/mL and the mean steady state concentration is about 500 to about 1200 ng/mL. In another embodiment, the dosage is selected such that once administered to the subject, the Cmax in the subject is about 1,200 to about 3,100 ng/mL and the AUC is about 5,000 to about 43,000 ng·h/mL. In subjects with impaired renal function, the dosages needed to achieve a particular AUCss, AUC, Cmax, and steady state mean concentration may need to be adjusted.
  • In a further embodiment, the Cmax, AUC0-tlast, and/or AUC may vary for a particular subject by about ±10%, by about ±20%, by about ±30%, or by about ±40% as compared to the values shown in Table 1.
  • The language “amyloid-related disease” refers to a pathological condition characterized by the presence of amyloid fibers. “Amyloid” is a generic term referring to a group of diverse but specific protein deposits (intracellular or extracellular) which are seen in a number of different diseases. Though diverse in their occurrence, all amyloid deposits have common morphologic properties, stain with specific dyes (e.g., Congo red), and have a characteristic red-green birefringent appearance in polarized light after staining. They also share common ultrastructural features and common X-ray diffraction and infrared spectra.
  • The invention also pertains, at least in part, to another method for treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a subject. This method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), which is administered in a dosage such that an effective systemic exposure is provided in a subject, for example, as measured by, e.g., AUC, Cmax, AUCss, Css, Tmax, etc.
  • The term “target plasma concentration” refers to a range of concentrations in the subject of the compound of the invention which result in treatment of the subject for AA amyloidosis. In one embodiment, the subject maintains a steady state concentration (Css) of about 500 to about 1200 ng/mL. In another embodiment, the subject maintains an AUCss from about 7000 to about 26,000 ng·h/mL. For example, the subject may maintain a steady state concentration of about 600 to about 700 ng/mL, or about 900 to about 1100 ng/mL and/or an AUC of about 8000 to about 9000 ng·h/mL, or about 11,000 to about 13,000 ng·h/mL, or about 23,000 to about 26,000 ng·h/mL, or about 15,500 to about 16,500 ng·h/mL. In a further embodiment the AUCss or the steady state concentration are within ±20% of these values.
  • In addition, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of stabilizing or improving renal and/or gastrointestinal function in a subject. The method includes administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I).
  • In a further embodiment, the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation. The formulation comprises an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. Furthermore, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about from 2900 to about 9000 ng·h/mL±20% and a mean Cmax of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL±20% is achieved. In alternate embodiment, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of from about 2,900 to about 9,000 ng·h/mL±20% is achieved. In another alternate embodiment, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean Cmax of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In another embodiment, the invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. In this embodiment, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of less than about 30 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 10,000-12,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-900 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of from about 30 to about 80 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 9,000-10,500 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 750-875 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1200 mg of the active agent to a subject having a creatinine clearance rate of greater than about 80 mL/min, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 5,000-6,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-925 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In another embodiment, this invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising 800 mgs of an active agent, which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. Furthermore, when this formulation is orally administered to a subject: when the subject is healthy, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 4,000-6,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 1,200-1,300 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the subject has mild renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 12,000-14,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,500-3,500 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the subject has moderate renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 9,000-11,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,000-2,200 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the subject has severe renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 40,000-46,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,100-2,300 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In another further embodiment, the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. Furthermore, when this formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis for twenty-four months: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 25,000-26,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,000-2,300 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 20,000-22,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 1,600-2,000 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1200 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 8,000-10,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-1,000 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In another embodiment, the invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent which is 1,3-propane disulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier. Furthermore, wherein, when this formulation is orally administered to healthy male subjects for seven days: in a dose of 400 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 10,000-11,500 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 900-1100 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 19,000-21,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 1,600-1,800 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1600 mg TID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 25,000-27,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 4,000-6,000 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1600 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 23,000-25,500 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 4,500-6,500 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In another further embodiment, the invention also pertains to a method of stabilizing or improving renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes orally administering a formulation comprising 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, in an amount determined in accordance with the subject's rate of creatinine clearance. Furthermore, when the formulation is administered in a dose of 400 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid having a mean AUC of about 10,000-12,000 ng·h/mL 20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-900 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 800 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 9,000-10,500 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 750-875 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the formulation is administered in a dose of 1200 mg, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 5,000-6,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-925 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In a further embodiment, the dose is 400 mg when the subject's rate of creatinine clearance is less than about 30 mL/min, the dose is 800 mg when the subject's rate of creatinine clearance is from about 30 to about 80 ml/min, and the dose is 1200 mg when the subject's rate of creatinine clearance is greater than about 80 mL/min. In another further embodiment, the subject's rate of creatinine clearance is about 60 to about 90 mL/min and a dose of 1200 mg is administered.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains to a method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a subject. The method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a second agent, such that AA amyloidosis is treated or prevented.
  • The term “in combination with” refers to the concurrent administration of a compound of formula (I) and a second agent; the administration of the compound of formula (I) prior to the administration of the second agent; or administration of the second agent prior to administration of the compound of formula (I).
  • The term “second agent” includes drugs known to treat underlying diseases, e.g., inflammatory diseases (e.g., chronic inflammatory disease, rheumatoid arthritis, juvenile chronic arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriasis, psoriatic arthropathy, Reiter's syndrome, psoriatic arthritis, lupus erythematosus arthritis, periarthritis nodosa, Wegner's granulomatosis, Muckle-Wells syndrome, Adult Still's disease, Behcet's syndrome, familial Mediterranean fever, inflammatory bowel disease, hereditary periodic fevers, and Crohn's disease, etc.), diseases associated with chronic infections (e.g., AIDS, HIV, hepatitis B, hepatitis C, etc.), diseases associated with chronic microbial infections (e.g., leprosy, tuberculosis, bronchiectasis, decubitus ulcers, pyelonephritis, osteomyelitis, Whipple's disease, acne conglobata, common variable immunodeficiency, pulmonary tuberculosis, pulmonary infection(s), recurrent abscesses, Behcet's Disease, hypolagammaglobulinemia, cystic fibrosis, etc.), or certain malignant neoplasms (e.g., Hodgkin's lymphoma, renal carcinoma, carcinomas of gut, lung and urogenital tract, basal cell carcinoma, Castleman's disease, Schnitzler's syndrome, hepatoma, Waldenstrom's disease, and hairy cell leukemia). The term “second agent” also includes rescue agents, chemotherapeutic agents, anti-inflammatory agents, e.g., non-steroidal anti-inflammatory agents, etc., and antibiotics. Examples of second agents include methotrexate, colchicine, anti-TNF antibodies and anti-interleukin 1 or 6 antibodies.
  • Examples of nonsteroidal anti-inflammatory agents (“NSAIDs”) include ibuprofen, naproxen, sulindac, and indomethacin. Other anti-inflammatory agents include COX-2 inhibitors (such as Vioxx™ and Celebrex™), cytokine inhibitors (such as thalidomide disclosed in WO 95/04533 and dexanabinol) complement inhibitors, leukotriene receptor antagonists and combinations thereof. Examples include acetic acid derivatives sulindac (Clinoril™, Merck & Co., Inc., Rahway, N.J.), indomethacin (Indocin™, Merck & Co., Inc., Rahway, N.J.); etodolac (Lodine™, Wyeth, Madison, N.J.), nabumetone (Relafen™, GlaxoSmithKline, Middlesex, England), tolmetin sodium (Tolectin™, McNeil Pharmaceuticals, Spring House, Pa.); anthranilic acid derivatives: meclofenamate sodium (Meclomen™, Pfizer, New York, N.Y.), mefenamic acid (Ponstel™, Pfizer, New York, N.Y.); enolic acid derivatives: piroxicam (Feldene™, Pfizer, New York, N.Y.), Mobic™ (meloxicam); phenylacetic acid derivatives: arthrotec (diclofenac/misoprostol), Voltaren™ (diclofenac); propionic acid derivatives: naproxen sodium (Anaprox™, Naprosyn™, Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. (Roche), Nutley, N.J.), flurbiprofen (Ansaid™, Upjohn, now Pfizer, New York, N.Y.), oxaprozin (Daypro™, G.D Searle, now Pfizer, New York, N.Y.); ibuprofen (Motrin™, Upjohn, now Pfizer, New York, N.Y.), fenoprofen calcium (Nalfon™, Dista, Ranbaxy, Princeton, N.J.), ketoprofen (Oruvail™ or Orudis™, Wyeth, Madison, N.J.), ketorolac tromethamine (Toradol™, Syntex Laboratories, Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. (Roche), Nutley, N.J.); salicylic acid derivative: diflunisal (Dolobid™, Merck & Co., Inc., Rahway, N.J.); and COX-2 selective inhibitors: Bextra™ (valdecoxib), Celebrex™ (celecoxib, Pfizer, New York, N.Y.), and Vioxx™ (rofecoxib, Merck & Co., Inc., Rahway, N.J.), and cyclosporin (Maas BiolAB, Albuquerque, N. Mex.).
  • The language “chemotherapeutic agent” includes agents which inhibit the growth of proliferating cells or tissues wherein the growth of such cells or tissues is undesirable or otherwise treat at least one resulting symptom of such a growth. Examples of chemotherapeutic agents include: bleomycin, docetaxel (Taxotere), doxorubicin, edatrexate, etoposide, finasteride (Proscar), flutamide (Eulexin), gemcitabine (Gemzar), goserelin acetate (Zoladex), granisetron (Kytril), irinotecan (Campto/Camptosar), ondansetron (Zofran), paclitaxel (Taxol), pegaspargase (Oncaspar), pilocarpine hydrochloride (Salagen), porfimer sodium (Photofrin), interleukin-2 (Proleukin), rituximab (Rituxan), topotecan (Hycamtin), trastuzumab (Herceptin), tretinoin (Retin-A), Triapine, vincristine, and vinorelbine tartrate (Navelbine).
  • Other examples of chemotherapeutic agents include alkylating drugs such as nitrogen mustards (e.g., mechlorethamine (HN2), cyclophosphamide, ifosfamide, Melphalan (L-sarcolysin), Chlorambucil, etc.); ethylenimines, methylmelamines (e.g., hexamethylmelamine, thiotepa, etc.), alkyl sulfonates (e.g., busulfan, etc.), nitrosoureas (e.g., carmustine (BCNU), lomustine (CCNU), semustine (methyl-CCNU), streptozocin (streptozotocin), etc.), triazenes (e.g., decarbazine (DTIC; dimethyltriazenoimidazolecarboxamide)), alkylators (e.g., cis-diamminedichloroplatinum II (CDDP)), etc.
  • Other examples of chemotherapeutic agents include antimetabolites such as folic acid analogs (e.g., methotrexate (amethopterin)); pyrimidine analogs (e.g., fluorouracil (′5-fluorouracil; 5-FU); floxuridine (fluorode-oxyuridine); FUdr; Cytarabine (cyosine arabinoside), etc.); purine analogs (e.g., Mercaptopurine (6-mercaptopurine; 6-MP); Thioguanine (6-thioguanine; TG); and Pentostatin (2′-deoxycoformycin)), etc.
  • Other examples of chemotherapeutic agents also include vinca alkaloids (e.g., vinblastin (VLB) and vincristine); topoisomerase inhibitors (e.g., etoposide, teniposide, camptothecin, topotecan, 9-amino-campotothecin CPT-11, etc.); antibiotics (e.g., dactinomycin (actinomycin D), adriamycin, daunorubicin, doxorubicin, bleomycin, plicamycin (mithramycin), mitomycin (mitomycin C), taxol, taxotere, etc.); enzymes (e.g., L-asparaginase); and biological response modifiers (e.g., interferon-α; interleukin 2, etc.). Other chemotherapeutic agents include cis-diaminedichloroplatinum II (CDDP); crboplatin; anthracendione (e.g, mitoxantrone); hydroxyurea; procarbazine (N-methylhydrazine); and adrenocortical suppressants (e.g., mitotane, aminoglutethimide, etc.).
  • Other chemotherapeutic agents include adrenocorticosteroids (e.g., prednisone); progestins (e.g., hydroxyprogesterone caproate; medroxyprogesterone acetate, megestrol acetate, etc.); estrogens (e.g., diethylstilbestrol; ethenyl estradiol, etc.); antiestrogens (e.g tamoxifen, etc.); androgens (e.g., testosterone propionate, fluoxymesterone, etc.); antiandrogens (e.g., flutamide); and gonadotropin-releasing hormone analogs (e.g., leuprolide).
  • The term “antibiotic agents” include antibiotics known in the art to treat microbial infections. Examples of anti-biotic agents include, but are not limited to, amoxicillin, aminoglycoside, aminoglycoside analogs, beta-lactam, beta-lactamase, beta-lactamase analogs, clindamycin, chloramphenicol, cephalosporin, cephalosporin analogs, ciprofloxacin, ciprofloxacin analogs, erythromycin, fluoroquinolone, fluoroquinolone analogs, macrolide, macrolide analogs, metronidazole, penicillin, penicillin analogs, quinolone, quinolone analogs, rifampin, streptomycin, sulfonamide, tetracycline, tetracycline analogs, trimethoprim, trimethoprim-sulfamthoxazole, and vancomycin.
  • The term “rescue medication” refers to any medication commenced during treatment which has the potential to suppress the underlying disease, but which is introduced with the primary indication of ameliorating features of progressive AA amyloidosis. Such medications may include, but are not limited to, colchicine, cytotoxic agents, and anti-TNF agents.
  • Examples of anti-TNF agents include agents which inhibit TNF, e.g., anti-TNFα antibodies. Examples of anti-TNF agents include etanercept (Enbrel™, Amgen), infliximab (Remicade™, Johnson and Johnson, see, for example U.S. Pat. No. 6,790,444), human anti-TNF monoclonal antibody (D2E7/HUMIRA™, Abbott Laboratories), CDP 571 (Celltech), and CDP 870 (Celltech).
  • Examples of other second agents include immunosuppressants, corticosteroids (including systemically administered corticosteroids), sulfasalazine, renin-angiotensin system blockers or antagonists, diuretics (e.g., furosemide), calcium channel blockers, beta blocking agents, antirheumatic products, Angiotensin converting enzyme inhibitors (ACEi), Angiotensin II receptor blockers (ARBs), acetylsalicylic acid, amoxicillin, calcium, calcium carbonate, chlorambucil, colchicine, cyclophosphamide, diclofenac, enalapril, folic acid, methotrexate, methylprednisolone, omeprazole, paracetamol, prednisolone, and prednisone.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating an inflammatory disease in a subject. The method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a second agent such that the inflammatory disease is treated in the subject. In a further embodiment, the second agent is an anti-inflammatory agent.
  • The term “inflammatory disease” include diseases or disorders which are associated with inflammation and can be treated using the compounds of the invention. The inflammatory disease may include diseases which are associated with, cause, caused by, result from, or otherwise related to amyloidosis, e.g., AA amyloidosis. Examples of such inflammatory diseases include, but are not limited to chronic inflammatory disease, rheumatoid arthritis, juvenile chronic arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriasis, psoriatic arthropathy, Reiter's syndrome, Adult Still's disease, Behcet's syndrome, familial Mediterranean fever, inflammatory bowel disease, hereditary periodic fevers, psoriatic arthritis, lupus erythematosus arthritis, periarthritis nodosa, Wegner's granulomatosis, Muckle-Wells syndrome and Crohn's disease.
  • In a further embodiment, the therapeutically effective amount of the compound of the invention is effective to treat, prevent or delay the onset of AA amyloidosis and the second agent is administered in an effective amount to treat the underlying disorder, e.g., an underlying inflammatory disorder.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention includes a method of treating rheumatoid arthritis in a subject. The method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a second agent such that rheumatoid arthritis is treated in the subject. In a further embodiment, the second agent is an anti-inflammatory agent. In a further embodiment, the second agent is infliximab, which may be administered, for example by the procedure described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,790,444, incorporated herein by reference.
  • In a further embodiment, the second agent is an agent which is known to treat inflammatory diseases such as chronic inflammatory disease, rheumatoid arthritis, juvenile chronic arthritis, ankylosing spondylitis, psoriasis, psoriatic arthropathy, Reiter's syndrome, familial Mediterranean fever, Adult Still's disease, Behcet's syndrome, inflammatory bowel disease, psoriatic arthritis, lupus erythematosus arthritis, periarthritis nodosa, Wegner's granulomatosis, Muckle-Wells syndrome, hereditary periodic fevers, or Crohn's disease. Examples of agents which may be administered to the subject include, for example, anti-TNF agents, methotrexate, anti-inflammatory agents, and combinations thereof.
  • In a further embodiment, the therapeutically effective amount of the compound of the invention is effective to treat, prevent or delay the onset of AA amyloidosis and the second agent is administered in an effective amount to treat rheumatoid arthritis.
  • In a further embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of treating a malignant neoplasm in a subject. The method includes administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a second agent such that the malignant neoplasm is treated in the subject.
  • The term “malignant neoplasm” includes neoplasms which can be treated using the compounds of the invention. The malignant neoplasms may include neoplasms which are associated with, caused by, cause, result from, or otherwise related to amyloidosis, e.g., AA amyloidosis. Examples of such malignant neoplasms include, but are not limited to, Hodgkin's lymphoma, renal carcinoma, gut carcinoma, lung carcinoma, urogenital tract carcinoma, basal cell carcinoma, hepatoma, Castleman's disease, Schnitzler's syndrome, Waldenstrom's disease, or hairy cell leukemia.
  • Examples of second agents which may be useful for the treatment of malignant neoplasms include agents which are known to treat Hodgkin's lymphoma, renal carcinoma, gut carcinoma, lung carcinoma, urogenital tract carcinoma, basal cell carcinoma, or hairy cell leukemia. Further examples of second agents which may be used include chemotherapeutic or cytotoxic agents.
  • In a further embodiment, the therapeutically effective amount of the compound of the invention is effective to treat, prevent or delay the onset of AA amyloidosis and the second agent is administered in an effective amount to treat malignant neoplasm.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention pertains to methods of treating chronic infections. The methods include administering to a subject in need thereof, a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a second agent such that the chronic infection is treated.
  • The term “chronic infections” includes chronic viral, bacterial, fungal, and microbial infections which can be treated using the compounds of the invention. The infections may include infections which are associated with, cause, caused by, result from, or otherwise related to amyloidosis, e.g., AA amyloidosis. The microbial infections may be local or systemic. Examples of such microbial infections include, but are not limited to, acne conglobata, common variable immunodeficiency, hypolagammaglobulinemia, cystic fibrosis, leprosy, tuberculosis, bronchiectasis, decubitus ulcers, pyelonephritis, osteomyelitis, pulmonary tuberculosis, pulmonary infection(s), recurrent abscesses, Behcet's disease, and Whipple's disease. Other chronic infections include AIDS, HIV, hepatitis B, and hepatitis C.
  • Examples of second agents which may be useful for the treatment of infections include agents which are known to treat AIDS, HIV, hepatitis B, hepatitis C, leprosy, tuberculosis, bronchiectasis, decubitus ulcers, pyelonephritis, osteomyelitis, acne conglobata, common variable immunodeficiency, hypolagammaglobulinemia, cystic fibrosis, pulmonary tuberculosis, pulmonary infection(s), recurrent abscesses, Behcet's disease, or Whipple's disease. Examples of agents which may be administered to the subject include, for example, anti-inflammatory agents and antibiotic agents.
  • In a further embodiment, the therapeutically effective amount of the compound of the invention is effective to treat, prevent or delay the onset of AA amyloidosis and the second agent is administered in an effective amount to treat the chronic infection.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method of increasing the oral bioavailability of a compound in a subject, by administering to a subject a therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I) in a pharmaceutical composition without food such that the oral bioavailability of the compound in the subject is increased.
  • The term “oral bioavailability” refers to the quantity of drug reaching the bloodstream after oral administration. The term “increased oral bioavailability” refers to an increase in the bioavailability of about 5% or greater, about 10% or greater, about 15% or greater, about 20% or greater, about 25% or greater, about 30% or greater, about 35% or greater, about 40% or greater, about 50% or greater, about 55% or greater, about 60% or greater, about 65% or greater, about 70% or greater, about 75% or greater, about 80% or greater, about 85% or greater, about 90% or greater, about 95% or greater, or about 100% or greater.
  • In a further embodiment, the administration of the compound of the invention without food results in an increase in the maximal plasma concentration (Cmax) and extent of absorption (AUC) of the compound as compared to administration with food. The increase of the Cmax and/or the AUC may be about 5% or greater, about 10% or greater, about 15% or greater, about 20% or greater, about 25% or greater, about 30% or greater, about 35% or greater, about 40% or greater, about 50% or greater, about 55% or greater, about 60% or greater, about 65% or greater, about 70% or greater, about 75% or greater, about 80% or greater, about 85% or greater, about 90% or greater, about 95% or greater, or about 100% or greater as compared to administration of the compound with food. In a further embodiment, the subject is informed (e.g., by instructions by a physician or pharmacist, or by a label or insert accompanying the compound of the invention) that the administration results in an increase in the maximal plasma concentration (Cmax) and extent of absorption (AUC) of the compound as compared to administration with food.
  • The term “without food” refers to the administration of a medication or a composition of the present invention on a substantially empty stomach. Accordingly, in some embodiments, administration without food includes administration more than 15 minutes, 30 minutes, 60 minutes, 90 minutes, 120 minutes, 150 minutes, 3 hours, 4 hours, 5 hours, 6 hours, 7 hours or 8 hours after the most recent consumption of food. In other embodiments, administration without food includes administration at least 15 minutes, 30 minutes, 60 minutes, 90 minutes, 120 minutes, 150 minutes, 3 hours, 4 hours, 5 hours, 6 hours, 7 hours or 8 hours before the next consumption of food. In one embodiment, the term “without food” is administration of the compound of the invention at least one hour before a meal or at least two hours after a meal. In this embodiment, the term “about” includes values±10-20% of the indicated period.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains to a method of reducing the rate of progression of nephropathy in a subject in need thereof, as measured by, e.g., the occurrence of a doubling of serum creatinine, greater than or equal to a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance, dialysis/end-stage renal disease, and/or all-cause mortality. The may, for example, have AA amyloidosis, rheumatoid arthritis, chronic inflammation, chronic infection, hereditary fever, etc.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains to a method for preventing or delaying progression to End Stage Renal Disease (ESRD) and/or dialysis in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that progression to ESRD and/or dialysis is delayed or prevented.
  • In a further embodiment, the progression to ESRD and/or dialysis is delayed by 1 month or longer, 2 months or longer, 3 months or longer, 4 months or longer, 5 months or longer, 6 months or longer, 7 months or longer, 8 months or longer, 9 months or longer, 10 months or longer, or 12 months or longer. In yet a further embodiment, dialysis and/or ESRD is delayed six months as compared to a standard subject with a similar disorder who has not been treated with the compound of the invention.
  • In another embodiment, the risk of progressing to ESRD is reduced by about 0-78%. In another embodiment, the risk is decreased by about 5%, by about 10%, by about 15%, by about 20%, by about 25%, by about 30%, by about 35%, by about 40%, by about 45%, by about 50%, by about 55%, by about 60%, by about 65%, by about 70%, by about 75%, or by about 78%. In this embodiment, the term “about” includes values±5%.
  • In a further embodiment, the median time to dialysis is delayed by at least about 1 month, about 2 months, about 3 months, about 4 months, about 5 months, about 6 months, about 7 months, about 8 months, or about 9 months. In this embodiment, the term “about” includes the range of ±0.5 months of the indicated period. In a further embodiment, the median time to dialysis is 3.5 months±5.5, or up to 9 months longer in subjects with a compound of formula (I), e.g., PDS.
  • In a further embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for preventing or delaying the time to the doubling of serum creatinine in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the time to the doubling of serum creatinine is delayed or prevented.
  • In a further embodiment, the invention includes a method for preventing or delaying the time to at least 50% decrease in creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound, such that the time to the at least 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is delayed or prevented. In a further embodiment, the median time to at least a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is about 1 month, about 2 months, about 3 months, about 4 months, about 5 months, about 6 months, about 7 months, about 8 months, about 9 months, about 10 months, about 11 months or about 12 months in subjects treated with compounds of formula (I), such as PDS. In this embodiment, the term “about” includes the range of ±0.5 months of the indicated period. In a further embodiment, the median time to at least a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is up to 12 months longer in PDS treated patients.
  • In a further embodiment, the time to doubling of serum creatinine and/or the at least 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is delayed by 1 month or longer, 2 months or longer, 3 months or longer, 4 months or longer, 5 months or longer, 6 months or longer, 7 months or longer, 8 months or longer, 9 months or longer, 10 months or longer, or 12 months or longer. In another embodiment, the 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is delayed about 3 to about 5 months, or about 4 months. In yet a further embodiment, the doubling of serum creatinine and/or the at least 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is delayed at least about six months as compared to standard subject with a similar disorder who has not been treated with the compound of the invention. In a further embodiment, the time to the doubling of serum creatinine is delayed by about 3 months to about 5 months, or about 4 months.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention includes a method for decreasing the time to at least 50% increase in creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the time to the at least 50% increase in creatinine clearance is decreased.
  • In a further embodiment, the time to an at least 50% increase in creatinine clearance is decreased by 1 month or longer, 2 months or longer, 3 months or longer, 4 months or longer, 5 months or longer, 6 months or longer, 7 months or longer, 8 months or longer, 9 months or longer, 10 months or longer, or 12 months or longer. In yet a further embodiment, the at least 50% increase in creatinine clearance is decreased six months as compared to standard subject with a similar disorder who has not been treated with the compound of the invention.
  • In another further embodiment, the invention includes a method for reducing the rate of progression of renal disease as measured by the slope of creatinine clearance in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the rate of progression of renal disease is reduced, as measured, e.g., by a decline in the rate of decrease of creatinine clearance.
  • In a further embodiment, the slope of creatinine clearance is reduced by about 0-10 mL/min/1.73 m2/year. In another further embodiment, the slope of creatine clearance is reduced by about 1 mL/min/1.73 m2/year, by about 2 mL/min/1.73 m2/year, by about 3 mL/min/1.73 m2/year, by about 4 mL/min/1.73 m2/year, by about 5 mL/min/1.73 m2/year, by about 6 mL/min/1.73 m2/year, by about 7 mL/min/1.73 m2/year, by about 8 mL/min/1.73 m2/year, by about 9 mL/min/1.73 m2/year, or by about 10 mL/min/1.73 m2/year. In a further embodiment, the slope of creatinine clearance is reduced by about 4.7±5 mL/min/1.73 m2/year. In this embodiment, the term “about” includes values±0.5 mL/min/1.73 m2/year.
  • In a further embodiment, the rate of progression of renal disease is reduced by about 10% or greater, about 20% or greater, about 30% or greater, about 40% or greater, about 50% or greater, or about 60% or greater. In a particular embodiment, the rate of progression of renal disease is reduced by about 30% to about 40%.
  • The language “rate of change of creatinine clearance” refers to the rate of change in creatinine clearance normalized for a subject's body surface area over time. For example, a subject's creatinine clearance can be measured through, for example, a 24 hr urine collection at designated time points. This creatinine clearance is normalized for body surface area and the least-squares estimate of the within-subject slope may be calculated using available creatinine clearance measurements for that subject. Generally, the slope of creatinine clearance is expressed as an annual rate of change. A suitable transformation (i.e. log transformation) may be applied, if necessary, prior to the slope calculation.
  • In a further embodiment, the rate of change of a subject's creatinine clearance is improved by about 1 mL/min/year or more; about 2 mL/min/year or more; about 3 mL/min/year or more; about 4 mL/min/year or more; about 5 mL/min/year or more; about 6 mL/min/year or more; about 7 mL/min/year or more; about 8 mL/min/year or more; about 9 mL/min/year or more; or about 10 mL/min/year or more. In a further embodiment, the decrease in the rate of the creatinine clearance is lessened by about 2 to about 5 mL/min/year.
  • In a further embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for stabilizing or reducing proteinuria in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the proteinuria in the subject is stabilized or reduced. In one embodiment, the proteinuria is reduced by about 0.5 g/24 hours or more; about 1 g/24 hours; about 1.5 g/24 hours; or by about 2 g/24 hours. In one embodiment, the proteinuria is stabilized at below or equal to 1 g/24 hours.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for stabilizing renal function or delaying progression of renal disease in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the subject's renal function is stabilized or the progression of renal disease is delayed.
  • In a further embodiment, the progression of renal disease is delayed by 1 month or longer, 2 months or longer, 3 months or longer, 4 months or longer, 5 months or longer, 6 months or longer, 7 months or longer, 8 months or longer, 9 months or longer, 10 months or longer, or 12 months or longer.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention pertains to a method for treating renal impairment in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I), such that the renal impairment is treated
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for preventing or delaying progression to nephrotic syndrome in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), e.g. 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that progression to nephrotic syndrome is prevented or delayed.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for treating nephrotic syndrome in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), e.g. 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that the parameters associated with nephrotic syndrome are improved or nephrotic syndrome is remitted.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for sustaining remission of nephrotic syndrome in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), e.g. 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that remission of nephrotic syndrome is sustained over a period of, e.g., about 4, 6, 8, 10 or 12 months. In a particular embodiment, remission of nephrotic syndrome is sustained in a patient over a period of about 6 to about 8 months.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a method for stabilizing or increasing GFR in a subject having AA amyloidosis. The method includes administering to the subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of Formula (I), e.g. 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof, e.g. a disodium salt, such that GFR is stabilized or increased.
  • The terms “glomerular filtration rate” and “GFR” are used interchangeably herein and are an indicator of kidney function. One measure of a subject's GFR, for example, is the rate of creatinine clearance. Renal function and/or GFR can be assessed using a number of criteria, such as, for example: serum creatinine levels, urinary creatinine levels, urinary albumin levels, urinary microproteins levels (e.g. retinol binding protein, N-acetyl-β-D-glucosaminidase, microalbumin, etc.), plasma clearance of inulin, creatinine clearance, proteinurea, etc.
  • Furthermore, a subject may have mild, moderate or severe renal impairment. For example, a healthy subject typically has a GFR of greater than about 100 mL/min. A subject with “mild” renal impairment may, for example, have a GFR of about 50 to about 80 mL/min or a GFR of less than 100, or a creatinine clearance rate of about 60 to about 90 mL/min. A subject with “moderate” renal impairment may, for example, have a GFR of about 30 to about 50 mL/min, or a creatinine clearance rate of about 30 to about 60 mL/min. A subject with “severe” renal impairment may, for example, have a GFR of less than about 30 mL/min, or a creatinine clearance rate of about 15 to about 30 mL/min. Subjects may also be classified as mild, moderate or severe as described in the examples herein, or using criteria known in the art (see, e.g., McCullough, P. A., Rev. Cardiovasc. Med. 2003; 4(suppl. 1): S2-S6; K/DOQI guidelines at www.kidney.org/professionals).
  • In other embodiments, a subject may have a creatine clearance rate, before treatment (e.g., at baseline) of about 50 to about 120 mL/min, about 60 to about 100 mL/min, about 70 to about 110 ml/min, or about 70 to about 100 ml/min.
  • In a further embodiment, the subject is nephrotic. In another further embodiment, the subject is non-nephrotic. The subject may be suffering from a disorder such as, for example, an inflammatory disorder, a malignant neoplasm, or a chronic infection.
  • B. Compounds of the Invention
  • In an embodiment, the invention pertains to compounds of formula (I):

  • Y—(CH2)n—[CH2Y]m  (I)
  • wherein Y is SO3X or OSO3X independently chosen for each occurrence; X is cationic group independently chosen for each occurrence; n is 1, 2, 3 or 4; m is 1 or 2, provided that when m is 2, one hydrogen of the —(CH2)n— group is absent.
  • The term “cationic group” includes groups with a positive charge and hydrogen atoms. Examples of cations include pharmaceutically acceptable salts of the SO3 or OSO3 . Examples of cationic groups include ions of alkali or alkaline earth metals, such as lithium, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and aluminum and the like. In a further embodiment, the cationic groups are H+ or Na+.
  • Examples of compounds of the invention include the compounds below and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof.
  • 1,2-Ethanedisulfonic acid HO3SCH2CH2SO3H
    Sodium 1,2-ethanedisulfonate NaO3SCH2CH2SO3NA
    1,3-propanedisulfonic acid HO3SCH2CH2CH2SO3H
    Sodium 1,3-propanedisulfonate (1,3- NaO3SCH2CH2CH2SO3Na
    propanedisulfonic acid,
    disodium salt)
    1,2-Ethanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate) HO3SOCH2CH2OSO3H
    1,2-Ethanediol disulfate, disodium NaO3SOCH2CH2OSO3Na
    salt
    1,3-Propanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate) HO3SOCH2CH2CH2OSO3H
    1,3-Propanediol disulfate, disodium NaO3SOCH2CH2CH2OSO3Na
    salt
    2-Sulfomethyl-1,4-butanedisulfonic HO3SCH2CH2CH(CH2SO3H)2
    acid
    2-Sulfomethylbutane-1,4-disulfonic NaO3SCH2CH2CH(CH2SO3Na)2
    acid, trisodium salt
  • In one embodiment, the compound or anti-amyloidogenic agent is not 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid. In another embodiment, the compound or anti-amyloidogenic agent is not 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt.
  • The term “compound” includes chemical entities. The compounds may be in solid, liquid or gaseous phase. The term compound includes the compounds of formula (I) and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof. Compounds of the invention are identified herein by their chemical structure and/or chemical name. Where a compound is referred to by both a chemical structure and a chemical name, and that chemical structure and chemical name conflict, the chemical structure is determinative of the compound's identity. The compounds of the invention may contain a chiral center and, therefore, may exist as stereoisomers. Compounds, as defined herein, may be purified from natural sources, purchased from commercial sources or chemically synthesized using art recognized techniques.
  • In addition, the compounds of the invention also may exist in hydrated and anhydrous forms. Hydrates of the compound of formula (I) are included as compounds of formula (I). In a further embodiment, the compound of formula (I) is a monohydrate. In one embodiment, the compound of formula (I) comprises about 10% or less, about 9% or less, about 8% or less, about 7% or less, about 6% or less, about 5% or less, about 4% or less, about 3% or less, about 2% or less, about 1% or less, about 0.5% or less, about 0.1% or less by weight of water. In another embodiment, the compounds of the invention comprise, about 0.1% or more, about 0.5% or more, about 1% or more, about 2% or more, about 3% or more, about 4% or more, about 5% or more, or about 6% or more by weight of water.
  • In addition, the compounds of the invention may also encompass more than one polymorphic forms, hydrated states, etc. For example, one form, Form I, can be prepared by direct recrystallization of a compound of the invention, e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid, disodium salt. The compound is precipitated from solution with 16:1 ethanol:water (v/v). The recrystallized product is recovered as a fine white powder which is then dried at 65° C. for 16 hours at 4 mm Hg. The resulting non-hydrated form has a moisture content of 0.2% and an apparent density of 0.64 g/ml. In a further embodiment, the compound of formula (I) has a moisture content of about 0.2%.
  • Furthermore, another form, Form II, can be prepared by direct recrystallization of a commercially available 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid, disodium salt in a fashion similar to Form I. The compound is precipitated from solution with 8:1 ethanol:water (v/v). The recrystallized product is recovered as a white solid which is then dried at 20-25° C. for 16 hours at 4 mm Hg. The resulting mono-hydrated form has a moisture content of about 7% w/w and an apparent density of 0.46 g/ml. In a further embodiment, the compound of formula (I) has a moisture content of about 7%.
  • Form I can be also be prepared from the Form II polymorph by prolonged heating at reduced pressures. First, the Form II polymorph (water content 6.8%) is dried at 65° C. for 16 hours in a vacuum at 4 mm Hg. This initial drying reduces the water content of the formerly hydrated polymorph to 2.3%. After another 24 hours at 65° C., the moisture content of the formerly monohydrated polymorph is reduced to 1%. The compound is entirely converted to Form I polymorph only after an additional 48 hours of drying at 77° C.
  • The compounds of the present invention contain one or more acidic functional groups and, thus, are capable of forming pharmaceutically acceptable salts with pharmaceutically acceptable bases. The term “pharmaceutically acceptable salts” in these instances refers to the relatively non-toxic, inorganic and organic base addition salts of compounds of the present invention.
  • These salts can likewise be prepared in situ during the final isolation and purification of the agents, or by separately reacting the purified agent in its free acid form with a suitable base, such as the hydroxide, carbonate or bicarbonate of a pharmaceutically acceptable metal cation, with ammonia, or with a pharmaceutically acceptable organic primary, secondary or tertiary amine. Representative alkali or alkaline earth salts include the lithium, sodium, potassium, calcium, magnesium, and aluminum salts and the like. Representative organic amines useful for the formation of base addition salts include ethylamine, diethylamine, ethylenediamine, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, piperazine and the like.
  • “Pharmaceutically acceptable salts” also includes, for example, derivatives of agents modified by making base salts thereof, as described further below and elsewhere in the present application. Examples of pharmaceutically acceptable salts include alkali or organic salts of acidic residues such as sulfonates. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts include the conventional non-toxic salts or the quaternary ammonium salts of the parent agent formed, for example, from non-toxic inorganic or organic acids. Such conventional non-toxic salts include those derived from inorganic acids such as hydrochloric, hydrobromic, sulfuric, sulfamic, phosphoric, and nitric acid; and the salts prepared from organic acids such as acetic, propionic, succinic, glycolic, stearic, lactic, malic, tartaric, citric, ascorbic, palmoic, maleic, hydroxymaleic, phenylacetic, glutamic, mesylate, benzoic, salicylic, sulfanilic, 2-acetoxybenzoic, fumaric, toluenesulfonic, methanesulfonic, ethane disulfonic, oxalic, and isethionic acid. Pharmaceutically acceptable salts may be synthesized from the parent agent which contains a basic or acidic moiety by conventional chemical methods. Generally, such salts may be prepared by reacting the free acid or base forms of these agents with a stoichiometric amount of the appropriate base or acid in water or in an organic solvent, or in a mixture of the two.
  • All acid, salt, base, and other ionic and non-ionic forms of the compounds described are included as compounds of the invention. For example, if a compound is shown as an acid herein, the salt forms of the compound are also included. Likewise, if a compound is shown as a salt, the acid and/or basic forms are also included.
  • In a further embodiment, the compound of formula (I) is not 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid.
  • C. Formulations of the Invention
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation for treating AA amyloidosis, comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in a formulation such that the formulation has at least one favorable biological property (FBP) upon administration to a subject.
  • The term “pharmaceutical formulation” includes pharmaceutical compositions as described below. In a further embodiment, the pharmaceutical formulations are designed to have favorable biological properties which enhance the ability of the compounds of the invention to treat AA amyloidosis and/or amyloid related diseases. The favorable biological properties of the formulation were discovered by administering the compounds of the invention to subjects during clinical trials.
  • The term “favorable biological property” includes biological properties other than the ability of the compound of the invention to inhibit AA amyloidosis and/or treat an amyloid related disease, which enhance the ability of the compound of the invention to perform its intended function, e.g., treat AA amyloidosis and/or an amyloid related disease. In one embodiment, the favorable biological properties can be a pharmacokinetic profile. Examples of such parameters which may be used, include, but are not limited to Cmax, Css, Tmax, AUC0-t, AUC, and T1/2. These parameters (Cmax, Tmax, AUC0-t, AUC, and T1/2 may be derived, for example, by non-compartmental analysis using WinNonlin® (Pharsight Corporation, Mountain View, Calif.) or SAS® for Windows® (SAS Institute Inc., Cary, N.C.). In a further embodiment, the favorable biological property is a target plasma concentration or a target systemic exposure.
  • The term “Cmax” refers to the maximum observed plasma concentration of the compound of the invention in a particular subject.
  • The term “Css” refers to the steady state plasma concentration of the compound of the invention in a particular subject.
  • The term “Tmax” refers to the time of the occurrence of the Cmax.
  • The term “AUC0-t” refers to the area under the plasma concentration versus time curve from time zero to the last sampling time at which concentrations were at or above the limit of quantification, calculated by the linear trapezoidal rule.
  • The term “AUC” refers to the area under the plasma concentrations versus time curve from time zero to infinity, calculated from AUC0-t+(Clastz), where Clast is the last observed quantifiable concentration and λz is the apparent terminal rate constant.
  • The term “T1/2” refers to the apparent terminal half-life, calculated from ln 2λz.
  • The invention also includes formulations and compositions which combine two or more favorable biological properties, such as pharmacokinetic parameters or combinations thereof. Examples of these pharmacokinetic parameters include AUC0-t, AUC, Cmax and/or Tmax. For example, the formulations of the invention may be selected such that when administered to a healthy subject (or one without renal impairment), the selected formulation provides the subject with one or more of the desired pharmacokinetic parameters. Alternatively, the formulations of the invention may be selected such that when administered to a subject with impaired renal function and/or subjects with AA amyloidosis or at risk for AA amyloidosis, the selected formulation provides the subject with one or more of the desired pharmacokinetic parameters.
  • In a further embodiment, the formulation is not as described in Example 7. In another further embodiment, at least one ingredient is not an ingredient described in Example 7.
  • In another further embodiment, the formulation has a diluent that is not lactose monohydrate. Examples of diluents that are not lactose monohydrate include, for example, sugars (e.g., glucose, sucrose, fructose, etc.), starches (e.g., corn starch, potato starch, etc.), cellulose, derivatives of cellulose (e.g., sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, ethyl cellulose, cellulose acetate, etc.), powdered tragacanth, malt, gelatin, talc, and mixtures thereof. In another further embodiment, the hygroscopicity of the diluent and/or lubricant is selected such that the resulting capsules are acceptable under FDA regulations.
  • In another further embodiment, the formulation has a lubricant that is not magnesium stearate. Examples of lubricants that are not magnesium stearate include, for example, stearic acid powder, talc, calcium stearate, polyethylene glycol, sodium lauryl sulfate, and mixtures thereof.
  • In another embodiment, the formulation comprises less than about 0.5% (w/w) of any single known impurity, less than about 1.5% (w/w) of total sulfates, less than about 0.1% (w/w) total unknown impurities, and less than about 5.0% (w/w) impurities overall.
  • In another embodiment, the compound of formula (I) conforms to a reference standard IR (Infrared) spectra and/or IC (ion chromatography) of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid. In another embodiment, the compound of formula (I) comprises less than about 1.0% w/w of water. In yet another embodiment, the compound of formula (I) less than about 20 ppm of heavy metals and/or less than about 0.5% w/w residual solvent.
  • In another embodiment, the invention pertains to a biologically favorable formulation for treating AA amyloidosis, comprising an anti-amyloidogenic agent in a formulation such that the anti-amyloidogenic agent-containing formulation is equivalent to a standard formulation predetermined to have at least one favorable biological property upon administration to a subject such that it is a biologically favorable formulation.
  • The term “biologically favorable formulation” refers to a pharmaceutical formulation with at least one favorable biological property. In a further embodiment, the formulation has two or more, three or more, or four or more biologically favorable properties. In one embodiment, the biologically favorable formulation is formulated such that a target plasma concentration of the compound of the invention is reached in the subject 30 minutes or less, one hour or less, two hours or less, or five hours or less after administration of the compound to a subject.
  • In one embodiment, the biologically favorable formulation is selected based on a subject's creatinine clearance rate in order to achieve a particular AUCss and/or Css.
  • For example, the favorable biological property may be an AUCss of about 5000 ng·h/mL or above, about 6000 ng·h/mL or above; about 6500 ng·h/mL or above; about 7000 ng·h/mL or above; about 8000 ng·h/mL or above; about 9000 ng·h/mL or above; about 10,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 11,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 12,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 13,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 14,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 15,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 16,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 17,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 18,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 19,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 20,000 ng·h/mL or above, about 21,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 22,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 23,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 24,000 ng·h/mL or above; or about 25,000 ng·h/mL or above, In another embodiment, the favorable biological property is an AUCss of about 7000 ng·h/mL; about 8000 ng·h/mL or less; about 9000 ng·h/mL or less; about 10,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 11,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 12,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 13,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 14,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 15,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 16,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 17,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 18,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 19,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 20,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 21,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 22,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 23,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 24,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 25,000 ng·h/mL or less, or about 26,000 ng·h/mL or less.
  • The biologically favorable property may be a desirable steady state concentration (Css). For example, the favorable biological property may be a Css of about 500 ng/mL or above, about 600 ng/mL or above; about 700 ng/mL or above; about 800 ng/mL or above; about 900 ng/mL or above; about 950 or above ng/mL; about 1000 ng/mL or above; about 1100 ng/mL or above; or about 1200 ng/mL. In addition, the biologically favorable property may be a Css of about 1200 ng/mL or less, about 1100 ng/mL or less; about 1000 ng/mL or less; about 900 ng/mL or less; about 800 ng/mL or less; about 700 ng/mL or less; about 600 ng/mL or less; or less than about 500 ng/mL.
  • In another embodiment, the favorable biological property may be a Cmax (after a single oral administration of the compound) of about 250 to about 2000 ng/mL. In a further embodiment, the Cmax is about 250 ng/mL or greater; about 300 ng/mL or greater; about 350 ng/mL or greater; about 400 ng/mL or greater; about 500 ng/mL or greater; about 600 ng/mL or greater; about 700 ng/mL or greater; about 800 ng/mL or greater; about 900 ng/mL or greater; about 1000 ng/mL or greater; about 1100 ng/mL or greater; about 1200 ng/mL or greater; about 1300 ng/mL or greater; about 1400 ng/mL or greater; about 1500 ng/mL or greater; about 1600 ng/mL or greater; about 1700 ng/mL or greater; about 1800 ng/mL or greater; about 1900 ng/ml, or greater; or about 2000 ng/mL or greater. The term “about” in this embodiment, includes values±50 ng/mL of the indicated range.
  • In a further embodiment, the Cmax after administration of a single oral dose is about 850 ng/mL; about 1700 ng/mL or less; about 1600 ng/mL or less; about 1500 ng/mL or less; about 1400 ng/mL or less; about 1300 ng/mL or less; about 1200 ng/mL or less; about 1000 ng/mL or less; about 900 ng/mL or less; about 800 ng/mL or less; about 700 or less; about 700 ng/mL or less; about 500 ng/mL or less; about 400 ng/mL or less; or about 300 ng/mL or less. In another embodiment, the Cmax is at least 200 ng/mL after administration of a single oral dose of the compound. The term “about” in this embodiment, includes values±50 ng/mL of the indicated range.
  • In another embodiment, the favorable biological property may be a Cmax (after multiple oral administrations of the compound) of about 400 to about 3800 ng/mL. In a further embodiment, the Cmax is about 400 ng/mL or greater; about 500 ng/mL or greater; about 600 ng/mL or greater; about 700 ng/mL or greater; about 800 ng/mL or greater; about 900 ng/mL or greater; about 1000 ng/mL or greater; about 1100 ng/mL or greater; about 1200 ng/mL or greater; about 1300 ng/mL or greater; about 1400 ng/mL or greater; about 1500 ng/mL or greater; about 1600 ng/mL or greater; about 1700 ng/mL or greater; about 1800 ng/mL or greater; about 1900 ng/mL or greater; about 2000 ng/mL or greater; about 2100 ng/mL or greater; about 2200 or greater; about 2300 ng/mL or greater; about 2400 ng/mL or greater; about 2500 ng/mL or greater; about 2600 ng/mL or greater; about 2700 ng/mL or greater; about 2800 ng/mL or greater; about 2900 ng/mL or greater; about 3000 ng/mL or greater; about 3100 ng/mL or greater; about 3200 or greater; about 3300 ng/mL or greater; about 3400 ng/mL or greater; about 3500 ng/mL or greater; about 3600 ng/mL or greater; about 3700 ng/mL or greater; about 3800 ng/mL or greater; or about 3900 ng/mL or greater. The term “about” in this embodiment, includes values±50 ng/mL of the indicated range.
  • In a further embodiment, the Cmax (after multiple oral administrations) is about 500 to about 3900 ng/ml. In a further embodiment, the Cmax is about 500 ng/ml or less, about 600 ng/ml or less; about 700 ng/ml or less; about 900 ng/ml or less; about 1000 ng/mL or less; about 1100 ng/mL or less; about 1200 ng/mL; about 1300 ng/mL or less; about 1400 ng/mL or less; about 1500 ng/mL or less; about 1600 ng/mL or less; about 1700 ng/mL or less; about 1800 ng/mL or less; about 1900 ng/mL or less; about 2000 ng/mL or less; about 2100 ng/mL or less; about 2200 or less; about 2300 ng/mL or less; about 2400 ng/mL or less; about 2500 ng/mL or less; about 2600 ng/mL or less; about 2700 ng/mL or less; about 2800 ng/mL or less; about 2900 ng/mL or less; about 3000 ng/mL or less, about 3100 ng/mL or less; about 3200 or less; about 3300 ng/mL or less; about 3400 ng/mL or less; about 3500 ng/mL or less; about 3600 ng/mL or less; about 3700 ng/mL or less; about 3800 ng/mL or less; or about 3900 ng/mL or less. The term “about” in this embodiment, includes values±50 ng/mL of the indicated range.
  • For example, the favorable biological property may be an AUC of about 2000 ng·h/mL or above, about 3000 ng·h/mL or above, about 4000 ng·h/mL or above, about 5000 ng·h/mL or above, about 6000 ng·h/mL or above; about 6500 ng·h/mL or above; about 7000 ng·h/mL or above; about 8000 ng·h/mL or above; about 9000 ng·h/mL or above; about 10,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 11,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 12,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 13,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 14,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 15,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 16,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 17,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 18,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 19,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 20,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 21,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 22,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 23,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 24,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 25,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 26,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 27,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 28,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 29,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 30,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 31,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 32,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 33,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 34,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 35,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 36,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 37,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 38,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 39,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 40,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 41,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 42,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 43,000 ng·h/mL; about 44,000 ng·h/mL or above; about 45,000 ng·h/mL or above; or about 46,000 ng·h/mL. The term “about” in this embodiment, includes values±750 ng·h/mL of the indicated range.
  • In another embodiment, the favorable biological property is an AUC of about 2000 ng·h/ml; about 3000 ng·h/mL or less, about 4000 ng·h/mL or less, about 5000 ng·h/mL or less, about 5000 ng·h/mL or less, about 6000 ng·h/mL or less; about 6500 ng·h/mL or less; about 7000 ng·h/mL or less; about 8000 ng·h/mL or less; about 9000 ng·h/mL or less; about 10,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 11,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 12,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 13,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 14,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 15,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 16,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 17,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 18,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 19,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 20,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 21,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 22,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 23,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 24,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 25,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 26,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 27,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 28,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 29,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 30,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 31,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 32,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 33,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 34,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 35,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 36,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 37,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 38,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 39,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 40,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 41,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 42,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 43,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 44,000 ng·h/mL or less; about 45,000 ng·h/mL or less; or about 46,000 ng·h/mL or less. The term “about” in this embodiment, includes values±750 ng·h/mL of the indicated range.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation. The pharmaceutical formulation comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about from 2900 to about 9000 ng·h/mL±20% and a mean Cmax of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of from about 2,900 to about 9,000 ng·h/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS) in an amount effective to treat or prevent AA amyloidosis, and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a healthy subject, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean Cmax of about from 450 to about 2150 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 10,000-12,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-900 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 9,000-10,500 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 750-875 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1200 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 5,000-6,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-925 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention also pertains to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising 800 mgs of an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject: when said subject is healthy, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 4,000-6,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 1,200-1,300 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the subject has mild renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 12,000-14,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,500-3,500 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the subject has moderate renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 9,000-11,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,000-2,200 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or when the subject has severe renal impairment, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 40,000-46,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,100-2,300 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, which comprises an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to a subject having AA amyloidosis for twenty-four months: in a dose of 400 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 25,000-26,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 2,000-2,300 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 20,000-22,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 1,600-2,000 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1200 mg of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 8,000-10,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 800-1,000 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical formulation, comprising an active agent (e.g., PDS), and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, wherein, when the formulation is orally administered to healthy male subjects for seven days: in a dose of 400 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 10,000-11,500 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 900-1100 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 800 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 19,000-21,000 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 1,600-1,800 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1600 mg TID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 25,000-27,000 ng·h/mL 20%, and a mean Cmax of about 4,000-6,000 ng/mL±20% is achieved; or in a dose of 1600 mg QID of the active agent, a mean plasma concentration profile of the active agent having a mean AUC of about 23,000-25,500 ng·h/mL±20%, and a mean Cmax of about 4,500-6,500 ng/mL±20% is achieved.
  • The term “equivalent” refers to a formulation which is considered a bioequivalent or functionally equivalent to a formulation of the invention. In a further embodiment, the formulation is equivalent to a formulation comprising 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid. In a further embodiment, the term includes formulations which meet the definition of bioequivalence under 21 U.S.C. §255 and/or 21 CFR §320. In another embodiment, “equivalent” refers to a formulation which, when administered to a subject, achieves pharmacokinetic parameters, e.g., Cmax, AUC, that are within, for example, +10%, +20%, ±30%, or ±40% of the values disclosed herein.
  • In a further embodiment, the term “equivalent” includes potentially equivalent formulations, wherein the rate and extent of absorption of the potentially equivalent formulation do not show a significant difference, e.g., within ±10%, ±20%, ±30%, or ±40% of the rate and extent of absorption of the standard formulation when administered under similar experimental conditions In another embodiment, the extent of absorption of the potentially equivalent formulation does not show a significant difference, e.g., within ±10%, ±20%, ±30%, or ±40% of the rate and extent of absorption of the standard formulation when administered under similar experimental conditions and the difference from standard formulation is not essential to the attainment of effective body drug concentrations on chronic use, and/or is considered medically insignificant for the drug. In one aspect, the same molar dose may be administered.
  • The term “standard formulation” refers to a formulation of a compound of formula (I), e.g., 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid, which has at least one favorable biological property. In other embodiments, the standard formulation meets or exceeds the requirements of the drug product specifications. In a further embodiment, the standard formulation is the formulation described in Example 7.
  • The term “drug product specifications” refers to a formulation wherein the formulation meets U.S. FDA drug product specifications. In a further embodiment, the formulation comprises not more than about 0.5% w/w of any single known impurity, not more than about 1.5% w/w of total sulfates, not more than 0.1% w/w of any single unknown impurity, and not more than about 5.0% w/w total impurities.
  • The term “anti-amyloidogenic agent” refers to a compound which tests positive in the AA Amyloid Binding Assay (AAABA). In a further embodiment, the anti-amyloidogenic agent binds to AA at a rate of 30% or greater, 45% or greater, 60% or greater, 70% or greater, 80% or greater, or 90% or greater at an AA amyloid concentration of 400 μM as measured in the AAABA. In another embodiment, the anti-amyloidogenic compound binds to AA at a rate of 30% or greater, 45% or greater, 60% or greater, 70% or greater, 80% or greater, or 90% or greater at an AA amyloid concentration of 200 μM, as measured in the AAABA.
  • The term “anti-amyoloidogenic agent” also includes disulfonated compounds and sulfonated alkyl compounds. In a further embodiment, the term includes compounds which are analogs of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • In a further embodiment, the anti-amyloidogenic agent is a compound of formula (I), as described above. Examples of anti-amyloidogenic agents include compounds such as 1,2-ethanedisulfonic acid, sodium 1,2-ethanedisulfonate, 1,2-ethanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate), 1,2-ethanediol disulfate disodium salt, 1,3-propanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate), 1,3-propanediol disulfate disodium salt, 2-sulfomethyl-1,4-butanedisulfonic acid, or 2-sulfomethylbutane-1,4-disulfonic acid trisodium salt. In a further embodiment, the anti-amyloidogenic agent is 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt.
  • AA Amyloid Binding Assay (AAABA)
  • In the MS assay for AA, samples are prepared as aqueous solutions (adding 20% ethanol if necessary to solubilize in water), 200 μM of a test compound and 20 μM of solubilized AA, or 400 μM of a test compound and 40 μM of solubilized AA. The pH value of each sample is adjusted to 7.4 (±0.2) by addition of 0.1% aqueous sodium hydroxide. The solutions are then analyzed by electrospray ionization mass spectrometry using a Waters ZQ 4000 mass spectrometer. Samples are introduced by direct infusion at a flow-rate of 25 μL/min within 2 hours after sample preparation. The source temperature is kept at 70° C. and the cone voltage is 20 V for all the analysis. Data are processed using Masslynx 3.5 software. The MS assay gives data on the ability of compounds to bind to soluble AA.
  • D. Pharmaceutical Compositions Comprising the Compounds of the Invention
  • The invention also pertains, at least in part, to a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) and second agent. In a further embodiment, the therapeutically effective amount is effective to treat AA amyloidosis.
  • In a further embodiment, the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition. The packaged pharmaceutical composition includes a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) packaged in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered in combination with a second agent. In a further embodiment, the therapeutically effective amount is effective to treat AA amyloidosis.
  • In yet another further embodiment, the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition, which includes a therapeutically effective amount of a second agent packaged in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered in combination with a compound of formula (I).
  • The term “label or insert” includes, but is not limited to all written, electronic, or spoken communication with the subject, or with any person substantially responsible for the care of the subject, regarding the administration of the compositions of the present invention. An insert may further include information regarding coadministration of the compositions of the present invention with other compounds or compositions, e.g., second agents. Additionally, an insert may include instructions regarding administration of the compositions of the present invention without food.
  • In yet another embodiment, the invention pertains to a packaged pharmaceutical composition, which includes a container holding a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound of formula (I) in combination with a label or insert advising that the composition be administered without food.
  • The compounds of formula (I) may be supplied in a solution with an appropriate solvent or in a solvent-free form (e.g., lyophilized). In another aspect of the invention, the agents and buffers necessary for carrying out the methods of the invention may be packaged as a kit. The kit may be commercially used according to the methods described herein and may include instructions for use in a method of the invention. Additional kit components may include acids, bases, buffering agents, inorganic salts, solvents, antioxidants, preservatives, or metal chelators. The additional kit components are present as pure compositions, or as aqueous or organic solutions that incorporate one or more additional kit components. Any or all of the kit components optionally further comprise buffers.
  • The compounds of formula (I) may also be administered parenterally, intraperitoneally, intraspinally, or intracerebrally. Dispersions can be prepared in glycerol, liquid polyethylene glycols, and mixtures thereof and in oils. Under ordinary conditions of storage and use, these preparations may contain a preservative to prevent the growth of microorganisms.
  • To administer the compound of the invention by other than parenteral administration, it may be necessary to coat the agent with, or co-administer the agent with, a material to prevent its inactivation. For example, the compound of the invention may be administered to a subject in an appropriate carrier, for example, liposomes, or a diluent. Pharmaceutically acceptable diluents include saline and aqueous buffer solutions. Liposomes include water-in-oil-in-water CGF emulsions as well as conventional liposomes (Strejan et al., J. Neuroimmunol. 7, 27 (1984)). It should be noted that the term “pharmaceutical composition” includes the “pharmaceutical formulations” described above.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions suitable for injectable use include sterile aqueous solutions (where water soluble) or dispersions and sterile powders for the extemporaneous preparation of sterile injectable solutions or dispersion. In all cases, the composition must be sterile and must be fluid to the extent that easy syringability exists. It must be stable under the conditions of manufacture and storage and must be preserved against the contaminating action of microorganisms such as bacteria and fungi.
  • Suitable pharmaceutically acceptable vehicles include, without limitation, any non-immunogenic pharmaceutical adjuvants suitable for oral, parenteral, nasal, mucosal, transdermal, intravascular (IV), intraarterial (IA), intramuscular (IM), and subcutaneous (SC) administration routes, such as phosphate buffer saline (PBS).
  • The vehicle can be a solvent or dispersion medium containing, for example, water, ethanol, polyol (for example, glycerol, propylene glycol, and liquid polyethylene glycol, and the like), suitable mixtures thereof, and vegetable oils. The proper fluidity can be maintained, for example, by the use of a coating such as lecithin, by the maintenance of the required particle size in the case of dispersion and by the use of surfactants. Prevention of the action of microorganisms can be achieved by various antibacterial and antifungal agents, for example, parabens, chlorobutanol, phenol, ascorbic acid, thimerosal, and the like. In many cases, isotonic agents are included, for example, sugars, sodium chloride, or polyalcohols such as mannitol and sorbitol, in the composition. Prolonged absorption of the injectable compositions can be brought about by including in the composition an agent which delays absorption, for example, aluminum monostearate or gelatin.
  • Sterile injectable solutions can be prepared by incorporating the therapeutic agent in the required amount in an appropriate solvent with one or a combination of ingredients enumerated above, as required, followed by filtered sterilization. Generally, dispersions are prepared by incorporating the therapeutic agent into a sterile vehicle which contains a basic dispersion medium and the required other ingredients from those enumerated above. In the case of sterile powders for the preparation of sterile injectable solutions, the methods of preparation are vacuum drying and freeze-drying which yields a powder of the active ingredient (i.e., the compound of the invention) plus any additional desired ingredient from a previously sterile-filtered solution thereof.
  • The compound of the invention can be orally administered, for example, with an inert diluent or an assimilable edible carrier. The compound of the invention and other ingredients may also be enclosed in a hard or soft shell gelatin capsule, compressed into tablets, or incorporated directly into the subject's diet. For oral therapeutic administration, the compound of the invention may be incorporated with excipients and used in the form of ingestible tablets, buccal tablets, troches, capsules, elixirs, suspensions, syrups, wafers, and the like. The percentage of the compound of the invention in the compositions and preparations may, of course, be varied. The amount of the compound of the invention in such therapeutically useful compositions is such that a suitable dosage will be obtained.
  • The present invention therefore includes pharmaceutical formulations comprising the compounds of the invention, including pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, in pharmaceutically acceptable vehicles for aerosol, oral and parenteral administration. Also, the present invention includes such compounds, or salts thereof, which have been lyophilized and which may be reconstituted to form pharmaceutically acceptable formulations for administration, as by intravenous, intramuscular, or subcutaneous injection. Administration may also be intradermal or transdermal.
  • In accordance with the present invention, an agent of formula (I) described herein, and pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, may be administered orally or through inhalation as a solid, or may be administered intramuscularly or intravenously as a solution, suspension or emulsion. Alternatively, the agents or salts may also be administered by inhalation, intravenously or intramuscularly as a liposomal suspension.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions or formulations are also provided which are suitable for administration as an aerosol, by inhalation. These formulations comprise a solution or suspension of the desired compound of the invention, or a salt thereof, or a plurality of solid particles of the agent or salt. The desired formulation may be placed in a small chamber and nebulized. Nebulization may be accomplished by compressed air or by ultrasonic energy to form a plurality of liquid droplets or solid particles comprising the agents or salts. The liquid droplets or solid particles should have a particle size in the range of about 0.5 to about 5 microns. The solid particles can be obtained by processing the solid agent of any compound of the invention, or a salt thereof, in any appropriate manner known in the art, such as by micronization. The size of the solid particles or droplets will be, for example, from about 1 to about 2 microns. In this respect, commercial nebulizers are available to achieve this purpose.
  • A pharmaceutical formulation suitable for administration as an aerosol may be in the form of a liquid, the formulation will comprise a water-soluble agent of a compound of the invention, or a salt thereof, in a carrier which comprises water. A surfactant may be present which lowers the surface tension of the formulation sufficiently to result in the formation of droplets within the desired size range when subjected to nebulization.
  • Peroral compositions also include liquid solutions, emulsions, suspensions, and the like. The pharmaceutically acceptable vehicles suitable for preparation of such compositions are well known in the art. Typical components of carriers for syrups, elixirs, emulsions and suspensions include ethanol, glycerol, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, liquid sucrose, sorbitol and water. For a suspension, typical suspending agents include methyl cellulose, sodium carboxymethyl cellulose, tragacanth, and sodium alginate; typical wetting agents include lecithin and polysorbate 80; and typical preservatives include methyl paraben and sodium benzoate. Peroral liquid compositions may also contain one or more components such as sweeteners, flavoring agents and colorants disclosed above.
  • Pharmaceutical compositions may also be coated by conventional methods, typically with pH or time-dependent coatings, such that the subject agent is released in the gastrointestinal tract in the vicinity of the desired topical application, or at various times to extend the desired action. Such dosage forms typically include, but are not limited to, one or more of cellulose acetate phthalate, polyvinylacetate phthalate, hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose phthalate, ethyl cellulose, waxes, and shellac.
  • Other compositions useful for attaining systemic delivery of the subject agents include sublingual, buccal and nasal dosage forms. Such compositions typically comprise one or more of soluble filler substances such as sucrose, sorbitol and mannitol; and binders such as acacia, microcrystalline cellulose, carboxymethyl cellulose and hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose. Glidants, lubricants, sweeteners, colorants, antioxidants and flavoring agents disclosed above may also be included.
  • The compositions of this invention can also be administered topically to a subject, e.g., by the direct laying on or spreading of the composition on the epidermal or epithelial tissue of the subject, or transdermally via a “patch”. Such compositions include, for example, lotions, creams, solutions, gels and solids. These topical compositions may comprise an effective amount, usually at least about 0.1%, or even from about 1% to about 5%, of a compound of the invention. Suitable carriers for topical administration typically remain in place on the skin as a continuous film, and resist being removed by perspiration or immersion in water. Generally, the carrier is organic in nature and capable of having dispersed or dissolved therein the therapeutic agent. The carrier may include pharmaceutically acceptable emollients, emulsifiers, thickening agents, solvents and the like.
  • Toxicity and therapeutic efficacy of such agents can be determined by standard pharmaceutical procedures in cell cultures or experimental animals, e.g., for determining the LD50 (the dose lethal to 50% of the population) and the ED50 (the dose therapeutically effective in 50% of the population). The dose ratio between toxic and therapeutic effects is the therapeutic index and can be expressed as the ratio LD50/ED50, and usually a larger therapeutic index is more efficacious. While compounds that exhibit toxic side effects may be used, care should be taken to design a delivery system that targets such agents to the site of affected tissue in order to minimize potential damage to unaffected cells and, thereby, reduce side effects.
  • It is understood that appropriate doses depend upon a number of factors within the ken of the ordinarily skilled physician, veterinarian, or researcher. The dose(s) of the small molecule will vary, for example, depending upon the identity, size, and condition of the subject or sample being treated, further depending upon the route by which the composition is to be administered, if applicable, and the effect which the practitioner desires the small molecule to have upon the subject. Exemplary doses include milligram or microgram amounts of the small molecule per kilogram of subject or sample weight (e.g., about 1 microgram per kilogram to about 500 milligrams per kilogram, about 100 micrograms per kilogram to about 5 milligrams per kilogram, or about 1 microgram per kilogram to about 50 micrograms per kilogram). It is furthermore understood that appropriate doses depend upon the potency. Such appropriate doses may be determined using the assays known in the art. When one or more of these compounds is to be administered to an animal (e.g., a human), a physician, veterinarian, or researcher may, for example, prescribe a relatively low dose at first, subsequently increasing the dose until an appropriate response is obtained. In addition, it is understood that the specific dose level for any particular animal subject will depend upon a variety of factors including the activity of the specific compound employed, the age, body weight, general health, gender, and diet of the subject, the time of administration, the route of administration, the rate of excretion, and any drug combination.
  • For subjects having AA amyloidosis or renal impairment, doses may depend on the state of renal function in the subject, as measured, for example, by the rate of creatinine clearance, which may affect the rate of clearance of the compound from the subject. In this case, subjects with a lower rate of creatinine clearance would be expected to achieve a particular plasma concentration at a lower dose than those with a higher rate of creatinine clearance.
  • Parenteral compositions may be formulated in dosage unit form for ease of administration and uniformity of dosage. Dosage unit form as used herein refers to physically discrete units suited as unitary dosages for the subjects to be treated; each unit containing a predetermined quantity of compound of the invention calculated to produce the desired therapeutic effect in association with the required pharmaceutical vehicle. The specification for the dosage unit forms of the invention are dictated by and directly dependent on (a) the unique characteristics of the therapeutic agent and the particular therapeutic effect to be achieved, and (b) the limitations inherent in the art of compounding such a compound of the invention for the treatment of AA amyloidosis or amyloid related disease.
  • For example, the therapeutically effective amount of the compound of formula (I) may be between about 100 and 2500 mg daily. The compounds of the invention may be manufactured in capsules with dosages of 200 mg, 400 mg, or 800 mg of the compound of the invention. Alternatively, the compounds of the invention may be administered with dosages of 400 mg BID, 800 mg BID, or 1200 mg BID.
  • Those skilled in the art will recognize, or be able to ascertain using no more than routine experimentation, numerous equivalents to the specific procedures, embodiments, claims, and examples described herein. Such equivalents are considered to be within the scope of this invention and covered by the claims appended hereto. The contents of all references, issued patents, and published patent applications cited throughout this application are hereby incorporated by reference. The invention is further illustrated by the following examples, which should not be construed as further limiting.
  • EXEMPLIFICATION OF THE INVENTION Example 1
  • An open-label, non-randomized, parallel group study to assess the pharmacokinetic profile of a single oral dose of 800 mg 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt (PDS) in subjects with varying degrees of renal impairment as compared to healthy volunteers is conducted. Blood and urine samples are collected for 24 hours following dosing. Plasma and urine concentrations in 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid are determined using validated HPLC methods. Overall, renal impairment is associated with lower renal clearance and greater systemic exposure (characterized by AUC and Cmax) to PDS compared to healthy subjects. Consequently, a decrease in dose appears to be necessary to maintain an acceptable systemic exposure in patients with impaired renal function. Results are shown in Table 1,
  • TABLE 1
    Degree of
    Renal Glomerular Filtration Cmax Tmax AUC0-Tlast AUC 2
    Impairment Rate (GFR)1 (ng/mL) (h) (ng · h/mL) (ng · h/mL)
    Healthy   >80 mL/min 1240 0.5 3158  5367
    (n = 6) (511-2080) (0.25-0.75) (1276-5019) (2937-8582)
    Mild 50-80 mL/min 3064 0.5 9107 12974
    (n = 6) (1113-6199)  (0.25-0.75)  (3794-15247)  (4773-19206)
    Moderate 30-50 mL/min 2105 0.5 9448 10740
    (n = 4) (851-4322) (0.25-2.0)   (5969-13773)  (7044-15462)
    Severe   <30 mL/min 2206 2.5 29163  43121
    (n = 6) (838-4043) (0.25-6.0)  (12933-58365) (23784-90825)
    Values are mean with ranges (minimum and maximum for individual patients) in parentheses except for
    Tmax for which the median is presented with the range in parentheses.
    1As determined by the inulin clearance.
    2Determined only for subjects for whom the elimination rate constant could be estimated.
  • Example 2
  • A multicenter, multinational, randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled, and parallel-design study to assess the efficacy and safety of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt (PDS) in subjects having secondary (AA) amyloidosis is conducted. A total of 183 subjects are randomized to receive either PDS or placebo twice daily for 24 months. Dosing depends on the severity of renal impairment in a subject: subjects having creatinine clearance (ClCr)>80 mL/min receive 1200 mg BID; for ClCr between 30 and 80 mL/min, the subject receives 800 mg BID; and for ClCr between 20 and 30 mL/min and until the possible initiation of dialysis, the subject receives 400 mg BID. If ClCr decreases or increases to the next lower or higher range level, the dose regimen is adjusted accordingly. Subject medication is administered orally (capsule). Each patient is evaluated on 16 occasions, including on-site visits at months 0 (baseline), 1, 4, 8, 12, 16, 20 and 24.
  • Changes from baseline in serum creatinine and creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area are assessed throughout the study (Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 visits). Subjects are asked to collect their urine for 24 hours as per instructions the day prior to the scheduled visit. The volume of urine is recorded in the case report form at study site and an aliquot of urine is sent to the central laboratory for determination of urinary creatinine. A blood sample is collected to measure serum creatinine. The creatinine clearance (ClCr) is calculated using the following formula and recorded in the case report form:
  • ClCr = urine creatinine ( mg / dl ) × urine volume ( ml ) serum creatinine ( mg / dl ) × time ( min )
  • The creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area is calculated by dividing the creatinine clearance by the body surface area. Body surface area is calculated with the following equation: Wt0.425×Ht0.725×0.007184 (DuBois D, Clinical Calorimetry, Arch Intern Med 1916; 17:87).
  • Subjects are classified into three categories based on a composite assessment of renal function at the end of the 24 month treatment period compared to baseline. Subjects are classified as “worse” if at least one of the following clinical milestones of worsening is met: a 50% reduction in creatinine clearance, a doubling of serum creatinine levels, progression to ESRD/dialysis, or death. Subjects are classified as “improved” if the following clinical milestones of improvement are met: % increase in ClCr and no clinical milestones of worsening. Subjects are classified as “stable” if none of the clinical milestones of worsening or improvement are met. Using this criteria, 13.4% fewer subjects receiving PDS are worse compared to those receiving placebo, and 13.4% more subjects receiving PDS are stable or improved compared to placebo (p value=0.06).
  • Example 3 Efficacy Analysis
  • All the statistical analyses will be based on the subject population as described. The “Safety population” will be the set of all subjects randomized to a treatment group who took at least one dose of the study drug (PDS). Subjects who were randomized during the screening period but did not meet one of the inclusion criteria at baseline and therefore did not take PDS will not be included in the Safety population. The “Intent-to-Treat (ITT) population” will consist of the Safety population, i.e., all subjects who are randomized and who have taken any amount of PDS. The “Efficacy Evaluable (per protocol; PP) population” will be a subset of the ITT subjects. It will consist of all subjects who complete the treatment period and can be assessed for the primary efficacy endpoint. It will exclude subjects under the following circumstances: initiation of angiotensin converting enzyme (ACE) inhibitor or angiotensin II receptor antagonist therapy during the study; use of rescue medications; discontinuations due to reasons other than progression to ESRD/dialysis or death; major protocol violations; and low compliance rate.
  • Primary Efficacy Endpoint
  • All subjects are categorized according to the evolution of their disease (“worse”, “stable”, or “improved”). This constitutes the primary efficacy endpoint for the study and is analyzed in the Intent-to-Treat (ITT) population according to two pre-specified statistical methodologies: 1) the Cochran-Mantel-Haenszel row mean scores test (CMH test) to compare the percentage of subjects who reach each category at the end of the study in comparison to their status at Baseline, and 2) a proportional hazards regression model (Cox analysis) to compare between treatment groups both the number of first “worse” events, as well as when they occur, thus making more use of all available data. Both methodologies are adjusted for the stratification of nephrotic status at Baseline (nephrotic vs non-nephrotic) as pre-specified.
  • For the primary endpoint using the CMH row mean scores test, summary statistics, such as the number and the percentage of patients who reach each category of this composite assessment at the end of the study are to be presented by treatment group. Since the response levels may not necessarily be viewed as equally spaced but have a clear ordering, the modified ridit scores option is to be used. This scoring method requires no scaling of the response levels other than that implied by their relative ordering. The CMH test statistic is not to be stratified by center because of the large number (27) of investigative sites relative to the sample size. The center effect is therefore to be investigated using only descriptive statistical methods. The country effect is also to be investigated descriptively.
  • If the sample size in certain cells is too small for the requirements of any statistical test, it is pre-specified that the “Improved” and the “Stable” categories of the composite variable will be collapsed to create a “Worse” versus “Stable or Improved” outcome. This is to apply to subgroup analyses or other exploratory analyses as well.
  • For the primary endpoint using the Cox proportional hazards regression model, the association between treatment and the composite endpoint can be adjusted for several Baseline variables, but to allow comparisons to the CMH test methodology, only the nephrotic status at Baseline (nephrotic vs non-nephrotic) is to be used initially for adjustments. Other variables which could be included in other analyses using the Cox model are: treatment groups, age, Baseline CrCl, Baseline proteinuria, Baseline SCr, and underlying disease (familial Mediterranean fever, rheumatic inflammatory diseases, and miscellaneous).
  • The primary efficacy endpoint is a composite assessment of clinical improvement/worsening of renal function. At the end of the study, the subjects are classified into three categories, “Worse” and death (all causes), “Stable”, or “Improved”. The subjects are classified as “worse” if at least one of the following clinical milestones of worsening is met: doubling of serum creatinine from baseline to Month 24; 50% or greater decrease in creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area from baseline to End of Study; progression to dialysis/ESRD; or death. The subjects are classified as “stable” if none of the clinical milestones of worsening or improvement are met. The subjects are classified as “improved” if the following clinical milestones of improvement are met: a 50% or greater increase in creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area from baseline to End of Study; and no clinical milestones of worsening. The term “End of Study” is defined as Month 24 for subjects who completed the study and as the last available measurement for the subjects who discontinued early.
  • At the End of the Study, it is found that there is a reduction in the risk of any “worse” event of renal decline or all-cause mortality to 42% of the risk for placebo. This is consistent with the result of fewer “worse” patients in the treated group. Furthermore, the median time to the first “worse” event is 6.4 months longer in subjects treated with PDS (14.5 months for treated vs. 8.1 months for placebo). A graph depicting a Kaplan-Meier curve for the time to the first “worse” event is shown in FIG. 1.
  • Secondary Efficacy Endpoints
  • The secondary efficacy endpoints are an assessment of clinical improvement/worsening of both renal and gastrointestinal functions. At the end of the study, subjects are classified into three categories based on their condition: worse, stable, or improved. Examples of secondary efficacy endpoints include 1) the slope of creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area over time; 2) the slope in the reciprocal of serum creatinine (1/serum creatinine) over time; 3) time to renal events (e.g., such as, time to doubling of serum creatinine; time to ≧50% increase in creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area; time to ≧50% decrease in creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area; time to dialysis/ESRD; and/or time to death); and 4) changes from baseline to End of Study in proteinuria and creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area.
  • For quantitative secondary efficacy parameters, summary statistics, such as the number of observation (n), mean, SD, median, minimum, and maximum values, are displayed by treatment group at each evaluation visit. The actual value and percent change from Baseline are also presented by treatment group at each evaluation visit. Moreover, treatment groups are compared using a two-way analysis of covariance (ANCOVA), controlling for Baseline and renal status at Baseline.
  • The initial full model to be tested will be:

  • Change from Baseline=Treatment+Baseline value+Renal status at Baseline+(Renal Status at Baseline*Treatment)+(Baseline value*Treatment)
  • where:
      • Treatment=PDS vs. Placebo
      • Baseline value=subject's baseline value for the tested parameter
      • Renal Status at Baseline=Nephrotic vs. Non-Nephrotic
      • Renal Status at Baseline*Treatment=Interaction term for Renal Status at Baseline by Treatment
      • Baseline value*Treatment=Interaction term for Baseline value by treatment
  • The two interaction terms will be dropped from the primary model if the test for their respective significance results in p-values greater than 10%. The primary test for treatment difference will be then done using the resultant model. If the assumptions underlying the ANCOVA model are not satisfied, then a rank transformation approach (Inman and Conover) will be used. Following the Iman and Conover procedure, the entire set of observations are ranked from smallest to largest, with the smallest observation having rank 1, the second smallest rank 2, and so on. In case of ties, average ranks will be used. Following the appropriate transformation, the procedure ANCOVA model without the baseline covariate will be applied to the transformed data in a manner similar to that described above.
  • For qualitative secondary efficacy parameters, the number and percentage of subjects in each category of the analyzed parameter will be displayed by treatment group at each evaluation visit. Moreover, treatment groups will be compared similarly to the primary efficacy endpoint, the using Cochran-Mantel-Haenszel (CMH) row mean scores test adjusted for the renal status at Baseline (nephrotic v. non-nephrotic).
  • At the End of the Study, it is found that the risk of doubling of serum creatinine is reduced by 59% as compared to the subjects treated with placebo. It is also found that the risk of ≧50% decrease in creatinine clearance is reduced by 52% and that the risk of dialysis/ESRD is reduced by 46% as compared to subjects treated with placebo.
  • Slope of Creatinine Clearance Normalized for Body Surface Area Over Time
  • The slope of creatinine clearance over time is commonly used clinically by nephrologists to predict long-term renal outcome and time to ESRD. A negative slope indicates a loss of renal function. The more negative the slope, the faster the loss of renal function.
  • Creatinine clearance is assessed at the Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 visits through a 24 hr urine collection at each time point. This parameter will be normalized for body surface area and the least-squares estimate of the within-subject slope will be calculated using all available creatinine clearance measurements. Although the study is for 2 years, the slope will be expressed as an annual rate of change. If the data exhibits a nonlinear change over time, then a suitable transformation (i.e. log transformation) will be applied prior to the slope calculation.
  • To assess the within-subject slope, a regression will be performed for each subject, thus providing a slope for each subject. Subsequently, summary statistics of the within-subject slope values will be presented by treatment group at each visit on both the ITT and Efficacy Evaluable populations.
  • At the End of the Study, it is found that treatment with PDS reduced the rate of loss in renal function in AA Amyloidosis subjects, as measured by the slope of creatinine clearance over time. There is a 30.1% reduction in the rate of loss of renal function in PDS-treated subjects (a mean difference of 4.7 mL/min/1.73 m2/year in treated vs. placebo), as shown in Table 2 and FIG. 2.
  • TABLE 2
    PDS PLACEBO
    STATISTICS (N = 89) (N = 94) P-VALUE
    n 85 86
    Mean (S.E.) −10.9 (5.1) −15.6 (4.0)
    Median −5.9 −8.6 0.025
    Range −355.4; 184.7 −258.8; 79.4
  • Slope of the Reciprocal of Serum Creatinine Over Time
  • Serum creatinine is assessed at the Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 visits. The least-squares estimate of the within-subject slope will be calculated using all available serum creatinine measurements. Although the study is for 2 years, the slope will be expressed as an annual rate of change. If the data exhibits a nonlinear change over time, then a suitable transformation (i.e. log transformation) will be applied prior to the slope calculation. These assessments will be made on the ITT as well as the Efficacy Evaluable population.
  • To assess the within-subject slope, a regression will be performed for each subject, thus providing a slope for each patient. Subsequently, summary statistics of the within-subject slope values will be presented by treatment group at each visit on both the ITT and Efficacy Evaluable populations.
  • Time (Month) Calculations
  • For the following calculations, summary statistics such as survival Kaplan-Meier estimates with 99% CI, quartiles and median survival time are presented by the treatment group on the ITT population. The 99% CI is based on the Greenwood variance formula. The KM estimates is presented for the following time windows: day 0 to 112, day 113 to 224, day 225 to 336, day 337 to 448, day 449 to 560, and more than 560 days.
  • The two treatment groups are compared using the stratified log-rank test and the stratification factor is the renal status at Baseline (nephrotic vs. non-nephrotic). Four groups are compared on a Kaplan-Meier plot to depict the time to event in each treatment group: baseline nephrotic (treated vs. untreated) and baseline non-nephrotic (treated vs. untreated).
  • Time to Double Serum Creatinine [ ( date of first event of doubled serum creatinine from Baseline - Baseline date ) + 1 ] 30.4375
    Time to ≧50% Increase/Decrease in Creatinine Clearance Normalized for Body Surface Area [ ( date of first event of 50 % increase / decrease from Baseline in creatinine clearance * - Baseline date ) + 1 ] 30.4375
    Time to Dialysis/ESRD [ ( date of dialysis / ESRD - Baseline date ) + 1 ] 30.4375
    Time to Death [ ( date of death - Baseline date ) + 1 ] 30.4375
    *normalized for body surface area
  • At the End of the Study, in those patients with a doubling of SCr, it is found that the median time to doubling of serum creatinine is 3.6 months longer in PDS treated subjects compared to placebo treated subjects. Furthermore, in those patients with a ≧50% decrease in CrCl, the median time to at least a 50% decrease in creatinine clearance is 4.4 months longer in PDS treated subjects in comparison to placebo treated subjects (see FIG. 3 for a Kaplan-Meier curve). In addition, in those patients progressing to dialysis, it is also found that the median time to dialysis is 5.3 months longer in PDS treated subjects in comparison to placebo treated subjects (see FIG. 4 for a Kaplan-Meier curve).
  • Changes from Baseline in Proteinuria and Creatinine Clearance
  • Proteinuria, creatinine clearance, and serum creatinine are assessed at Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 visits. Change from baseline to End of Study in Proteinuria and Creatinine Clearance will be analyzed as a secondary efficacy endpoint. The End of Study is defined as Month 24 for subjects who completed and as the last available visit for subjects who discontinued early. At Screening, proteinuria, creatinine clearance, and serum creatinine are to be collected from two distinct assessments which are to have been at least 1 week apart and within 3 months prior to study entry (Baseline visit). For the creatinine clearance parameter, the normalized value will be used.
  • Proteinuria/Creatinine Clearance/Serum Creatinine/Serum Albumin/Serum Alkaline Phosphatase
  • Proteinuria, creatinine clearance, serum creatinine, serum albumin and serum alkaline phosphatase are assessed at Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20 (except for serum albumin and serum alkaline phosphatase), and 24 visits. At. Screening, proteinuria, creatinine clearance and serum creatinine are to have been collected from two distinct assessments which had to be at least 1 week apart and within 3 months prior to study entry.
  • For the serum creatinine (SCr) parameter, both the value and its reciprocal, i.e., 1/SCr, will be analyzed. For the creatinine clearance parameter, the normalized value will be used. Summary statistics of the actual value of each of these parameters will be presented by treatment group at each visit on the ITT population. Summary statistics will also be provided for the change from Baseline and the percent change from Baseline at each post-Baseline assessment for each of these parameters.
  • For proteinuria and creatinine clearance normalized for body surface area, comparison of treatment groups will be done on the change from Baseline to Month 4, 8, 12, 16, and 20 as described for the secondary efficacy quantitative parameters. Similar models will be presented for changes from baseline to Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 in serum creatinine, serum albumin, and serum alkaline phosphatase.
  • At the end of the study, PDS treated subjects showed a mean difference in CrCl of −14.7±4.2 mL/min/1.73 m2 vs −22.3±4.1 mL/min/1.73 m2 in placebo treated patients (estimated difference of 7.7 mL/min/1.73 m2). Table 3 depicts data from this study which show the change from the baseline to the end of the study.
  • TABLE 3
    PDS PLACEBO
    PARAMETER STATISTICS (N = 89) (N = 94)
    Baseline n 85 86
    Mean (S.E.) 79.34 (5.79) 72.86 (5.78)
    Median 66.61 53.24
    Range 11.55; 265.73 9.43; 257.42
    Change from End of n 85 86
    Study to Baseline Mean (S.E.) −14.68 (4.19) −22.34 (4.07)
    Median −11.35 −13.79
    Range −226.14; 123.11 −176.08; 28.78
    p-value 0.058
  • Nephrotic Syndrome Status: Progression to and Remission
  • Nephrotic syndrome is defined in this example as heavy proteinuria (urinary protein >3 g/24 hr) associated with the two following extrarenal features: 1) hypoalbuminemia (serum albumin <3.4 g/dL) and 2) peripheral edema by physical examination and/or use of diuretics to treat edema.
  • Progression to nephrotic syndrome in subjects without nephrotic syndrome at baseline is defined as follows: an increase in proteinuria to >3 g/24 hr (needs to be ≦3 g/24 hr at Baseline) and occurrence of the two following extrarenal features: 1) hypoalbuminemia (not present at Baseline) and 2) edema and/or use of diuretics to treat edema (no edema and no use of diuretics at Baseline). If subjects do not meet all three criteria at the end of the study, they will not be considered nephrotic for the purpose of the study analysis. If subjects progress to ESRD/dialysis, and have missing information on either serum albumin or edema, they will not be considered as having progressed to nephrotic syndrome, but the information on their deterioration will nevertheless be captured in the primary endpoint analysis.
  • Remission of nephrotic syndrome in subjects with nephrotic syndrome at baseline is defined as follows: a decrease in proteinuria to ≦1 g/24 h (needs to be >3 g/24 hr at Baseline) and an improvement in one of the two following extrarenal features: 1) increase in serum albumin to 3.4 g/dL (if scrum albumin ≧3.4 g/dL at Baseline or at any other time during the study) or 2) resolution of edema and/or discontinuation of diuretics in response to improvement in edema (if edema was a presenting symptom or if a patient used diuretics at Baseline or at any other time during the study).
  • Orthostatic Hypotension
  • The autonomic nervous system (ANS) may be affected in AA amyloidosis. A postural decrease in blood pressure is defined as a drop from the supine to standing position of ≧20 mmHg in systolic blood pressure (SBP) or 10 mmHg in diastolic blood pressure (DBP). If the drop in systolic or diastolic blood pressure is sustained for at least 3 minutes, it is a sign of ANS dysfunction. Blood pressure is measured in the supine, standing, and standing-3-minutes-later positions at the Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20, and 24 visits.
  • Descriptive statistics such as the number and the percentage of subjects in each category (yes vs. no) is presented by treatment group and at each study visit on the ITT population. Treatment groups are compared using a CMH general association test adjusted for the renal status at Baseline.
  • Splenomegaly/Hepatomegaly
  • Splenomegaly is defined as an enlargement of the spleen. Spleen size will be measured by physical examination at Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20 and 24 visits. It is measured in centimeters from the left costal margin at then anterior axillary line, using a ruler. Measures are taken when the subject is lying down and at the end of inspiration.
  • Hepatomegaly is defined as an enlargement of the liver. Liver size will be measured by physical examination at Screening, Baseline, Month 4, 8, 12, 16, 20 and 24 visits. It is measured in centimeters from the right costal margin at the mid-clavicular line, using a ruler. Measures are taken when the patient is lying down and at the end of inspiration.
  • Pharmacokinetics Analysis
  • In the following examples, terms are as defined below. The pharmacokinetic parameters were derived by non-compartmental analysis using WinNonlin® (Pharsight Corp., Mountain View, Calif., USA).
    • Cmax—the maximum observed plasma concentration.
    • Tmax—the time of occurrence of Cmax.
    • AUC0-t—the area under the plasma concentration versus time curve from time zero to the last sampling time at which concentrations were at or above the limit of quantification, calculated by the linear trapezoidal rule.
    • AUC—the area under the plasma concentrations versus time curve from time zero to infinity, calculated from AUC0-t+(Clastz), where Clast is the last observed quantifiable concentration and λz is the apparent terminal rate constant.
    • t1/2—the apparent terminal half-life, calculated from ln 2/λz
    Example 4
  • The safety, tolerability and pharmacokinetics of PDS following single oral administration in healthy male adult volunteers is determined. The effect of food on the pharmacokinetics of PDS is also determined. The first part of the study is a randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled study to assess the pharmacokinetic profile of 6 single rising oral doses of PDS in healthy male subjects. The second part of this study is an open-label, two-way crossover study to investigate the effect of food on the pharmacokinetic profile of a single oral dose of PDS under fasted and fed conditions. Blood samples are collected during 36 hours following dosing. Plasma concentrations of PDS are determined using validated HPLC methods. Following single oral doses of PDS maximum plasma concentrations are generally reached within 0.5 to 1 hour post-dose and the mean half-life (T1/2) ranges from 2 to 26 hours. The extent of systemic exposure (AUC and Cmax) to PDS increases with increasing dose. This increase is reasonably proportional to the administered dose. Moreover, there is a decrease in both the rate and extent of systemic availability when PDS is administered under fed conditions. PDS should therefore not be given concomitantly with a high fat meal. Results are shown in Table 4.
  • TABLE 4
    Pharmacokinetic Parameters of PDS showing Single Oral Administration
    of 100, 200, 400, 800, 1600 and 2400 mg to Healthy Male Subjects and
    1600 mg to Healthy Male Subjects (Fasted and Fed state)
    Cmax Tmax AUC0-t AUC*
    (ng/mL) (h) (ng · h/mL) (ng · h/mL)
    Dose
    100 mg  99.5 1  240  419
    (n = 6)  (71.5-120)  (0.5-2.5)  (180-307)  (358-480)
    200 mg  164 1  626 NC
    (n = 5)  (112-228)  (0.5-2)  (217-1186)
    400 mg 1078 0.5  1884  2905
    (n = 5)  (167-2633) (0.25-1)  (751-3368) (1983-3828)
    800 mg 2867 0.5  4844  4553
    (n = 10)  (208-6068) (0.25-1.5) (1060-8965) (3200-6285)
    1600 mg 4762 0.5  8411 NC
    (n = 5) (1571-9862) (0.25-0.5) (6313-14741)
    2400 mg 6046 0.5 11986 12913
    (n = 5) (1440-8802)  (0.5-0.5) (5421-16001) (7350-16050)
    Fasted
    1600 mg 6455 0.5 11546 12807
    (n = 8) (2403-10417) (0.25-0.5) (6585-15776)
    Fed
    (high-fat
    meal)
    1600 mg  563 2.25  4014  6320
    (n = 8)  (228-1321)  (0.5-4) (2767-4608) (4394-9761)
    Values are the mean with ranges (i.e. minimum and maximum values for individuals) in parentheses, except for Tmax which is the median.
    NC: Not calculated
  • Example 5
  • The safety, tolerability and pharmacokinetics of PDS following multiple rising oral doses in healthy male adult volunteers is determined. This is a randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled study to assess the pharmacokinetic profile of single and repeated oral doses of PDS at 400, 800 and 1600 mg in healthy male subjects. PDS is administered as a single oral dose to healthy male subjects at 400, 800 and 1600 mg on Days 1 and 7. Following the single oral administration on Day 1, PDS is administered on Days 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6 at 400, 800 and 1600 mg four times daily, or 1600 mg three times daily. Blood samples are collected through 24 hours after the dose on Day 1, before the first and last doses on Days 2 through 6, and after 48 hours after the final dose on Day 7. Plasma concentrations of PDS are determined using validated HPLC methods. Following single and repeated oral doses of PDS maximum plasma concentrations are generally reached within 0.25 to 1 hour post-dose. The mean half-life (T1/2) ranges from 5 to 20 hours after single or multiple dosing. Accumulation after multiple dosing is consistent with the T1/2 and dosing frequency. The extent of systemic exposure (AUC0-t and Cmax) to PDS increases with increasing dose and this increase in systemic exposure is approximately proportional to the administered dose. Results are shown in Table 5.
  • TABLE 5
    Pharmacokinetic Parameters of PDS following Multiple Oral Doses of 400,
    800 and 1600 mg to Healthy Male Subjects
    Cmax Tmax AUC0-t
    (ng/mL) (h) (ng · h/mL)
    Dose Day 1 Day 7 Day 1 Day 7 Day 1 Day 7
    400 mg q.i.d.  496  995 1.0 0.25 1593 10498
    (n = 6) (150-1437) (425-2245) (0.5-3.0) (0.25-1.0) (751-2646)  (2357-26748)
    800 mg q.i.d. 2680 1675  0.25 0.25 5182 19938
    (n = 6) (1000-7767)  (913-2602) (0.25-0.50)  (0.25-1.50) (2384-10260) (11675-29457)
    1600 mg t.i.d.  2892 4893  0.375 0.5  7093 25797
    (n = 6) (708-7538) (1601-11370) (0.250-0.500) (0.25-0.5) (3919-12163)  (8686-34390)
    1600 mg q.i.d 2797 5476 0.5 0.25 8305 24474
    (n = 6) (387-6416) (1919-10972) (0.25-24)   (0.25-0.5) (4227-15418) (11002-58509)
    Values are the mean with ranges (i.e. minimum and maximum values for individuals) in parentheses, except for Tmax which is the median.
    NC: Not calculated
    Day 1 corresponds to parameters following a single oral administration.
    Day 7 corresponds to parameters following repeated oral administration.
  • Example 6
  • The safety, efficacy and pharmacokinetics of PDS after single and multiple oral administration in subjects with AA amyloidosis is determined. This is a multicenter, multinational, randomized, double-blind, placebo-controlled, and parallel-design study to assess the pharmacokinetic profile of single and repeated doses of PDS. Dosing depends on the severity or renal impairment in a subject: subjects having creatinine clearance (ClCr)>80 mL/min receive 1200 mg BID; for ClCr between 30 and 80 mL/min, the subject receives 800 mg BID; and for ClCr between 20 and 30 mL/min, the subject receives 400 mg BID. If ClCr decreases to the next lower range level, the dose regimen is adjusted accordingly. PDS is administered as a single oral dose for a subset of AA amyloidosis patients on Month 0 and 24 visits. Following the single administration on Month 0, PDS is administered twice daily for 24 months. Blood samples are collected through 24 hours after the doses on Month 0 and 24, and through 8 hours after the doses on Month 4, 8, 12 visits. Plasma concentrations of PDS are determined using validated HPLC methods. Following multiple dose oral administration of PDS, the range of accumulation across subjects is 1.75 to 3.44. Based on the accumulation factor, the mean T1/2 calculated is 15 hours with a range of 10 to 24 hours. Results are shown in Table 6.
  • TABLE 6
    Pharmacokinetic Parameters of PDS after Single (Month 0) and Multiple
    (Month 24) Oral Administration to AA amyloidosis Patients
    Parameters
    Cmax Tmax AUC(0-12) AUC(0-tlast)
    (ng/mL) (h) (ng * h/mL) (ng * h/mL)
    Month Month Month Month
    Dose Month 0 24 Month 0 24 Month 0 24 Month 0 24
    400 841 2157 3   1.83 7414 17557 11689  25699
    (580-1101) (1482-2572) (3-3)  (0.5-3) (4479-10358) (13315-25724) (6486-16893) (13315-42751)
    n = 2 n = 3 n = 2 n = 3 n = 2 n = 3 n = 2 n = 3
    800 812 1897 2.95 1.85 5948 13692 9809 21171
    (313-1177) (1114-2961) (0.75-7.98) (0.75-3) (2354-10319)  (8265-22368) (3324-19359) (11399-37734)
    n = 5 n = 4 n = 5 n = 4 n = 5 n = 4 n = 5 n = 4
    1200 867  637 0.69 0.68 4208  4928 5633  9144
    (420-1423) (NA) (0.5-1)   (NA) (2311-6688) (NA) (2707-10078) (NA)
    n = 4 n = 1 n = 4 n = 1 n = 4 n = 1 n = 4 n = 1
    Values are mean with ranges (i.e. minimum and maximum values for individuals) in parentheses.
    Month 0 corresponds to parameters following a single oral dose.
    Month 24 correspons to parameters following repeated oral doses.
    n = number of patients in each dose group
    NA = Not Applicable
  • Example 7
  • An example of a formulation of a 400 mg capsule of 1,3 propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt is described below.
  • Capsules of 400 mgs of 1,3 propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt are manufactured by filling #0 white opaque hard gelatin capsules with a white powder comprised of 400 mg of 1,3 propanedisulfonic acid disodium salt and 40 mg of excipients.
  • Label
    Raw Material Grade Function (mg/unit) %
    1,3 Propanedisulfonic Acid MHS* active 400.0 90.9
    Disodium Salt (PDS)
    Lactose Monohydrate NF diluent 37.8 8.6
    (316 Fast-Flo)
    Magnesium Stearate NF lubricant 2.2 0.5
    Sub-Total 440.0 100.0
    # 0 Hard Gelatin Capsule MHS* capsule 96.0
    Total 536.0
    *MHS—Manufacturer House Standard
  • Example 8
  • A pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 1,2-ethanedisulfonic acid as the active agent.
  • Example 9
  • A pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with sodium 1,2-ethanedisulfonate as the active agent.
  • Example 10
  • A pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 1,2-ethanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate) as the active agent.
  • Example 11
  • A pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 1,2-ethanediol disulfate disodium salt as the active agent.
  • Example 12
  • A pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 1,3-propanediol bis(hydrogen sulfate) as the active agent.
  • Example 13
  • A pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 1,3-propanediol disulfate disodium salt as the active agent.
  • Example 14
  • A pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 2-sulfomethyl-1,4-butanedisulfonic acid as the active agent.
  • Example 15
  • A pharmaceutical composition is formulated as described in Example 7 with 2-sulfomethylbutane-1,4-disulfonic acid trisodium salt as the active agent.
  • EQUIVALENTS
  • Those skilled in the art will recognize, or be able to ascertain using no more than routine experimentation, numerous equivalents to the specific procedures described herein. Such equivalents are considered to be within the scope of the present invention and are covered by the following claims. The contents of all references, patents, and patent applications cited throughout this application are hereby incorporated by reference. The appropriate components, processes, and methods of those patents, applications and other documents may be selected for the present invention and embodiments thereof.

Claims (1)

1. A method of treating or preventing AA amyloidosis in a target subject comprising,
administering to the target subject a therapeutically effective amount of a compound having the formula:

Y—(CH2)n—[CH2Y]m  (I)
wherein Y is SO3X or OSO3X independently chosen for each occurrence; X is cationic group independently chosen for each occurrence; n is 1, 2, 3 or 4; and m is 1 or 2, such that AA amyloidosis is treated or prevented while maintaining an acceptable tolerance index (ATI) for a parameter associated with renal impairment (PRI),
wherein the target subject is being treated for AA amyloidosis and has or is susceptible to a parameter associated with renal impairment.
US13/472,368 2005-04-15 2012-05-15 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis Abandoned US20120270939A1 (en)

Priority Applications (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US13/472,368 US20120270939A1 (en) 2005-04-15 2012-05-15 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis
US13/901,432 US20130296434A1 (en) 2005-04-15 2013-05-23 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis

Applications Claiming Priority (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US67186605P 2005-04-15 2005-04-15
US11/405,348 US8178580B2 (en) 2005-04-15 2006-04-17 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis
US13/472,368 US20120270939A1 (en) 2005-04-15 2012-05-15 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/405,348 Continuation US8178580B2 (en) 2005-04-15 2006-04-17 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US13/901,432 Continuation US20130296434A1 (en) 2005-04-15 2013-05-23 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20120270939A1 true US20120270939A1 (en) 2012-10-25

Family

ID=37499595

Family Applications (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/405,348 Expired - Fee Related US8178580B2 (en) 2005-04-15 2006-04-17 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis
US13/472,368 Abandoned US20120270939A1 (en) 2005-04-15 2012-05-15 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis
US13/901,432 Abandoned US20130296434A1 (en) 2005-04-15 2013-05-23 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis

Family Applications Before (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/405,348 Expired - Fee Related US8178580B2 (en) 2005-04-15 2006-04-17 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis

Family Applications After (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US13/901,432 Abandoned US20130296434A1 (en) 2005-04-15 2013-05-23 Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis

Country Status (25)

Country Link
US (3) US8178580B2 (en)
EP (2) EP2944308A1 (en)
JP (2) JP2008535906A (en)
KR (2) KR20130133915A (en)
CN (2) CN104873483A (en)
AU (1) AU2006264498B2 (en)
BR (1) BRPI0610592A2 (en)
CA (1) CA2582556C (en)
DK (1) DK1885350T3 (en)
EA (1) EA018898B1 (en)
ES (1) ES2534553T3 (en)
HK (2) HK1116686A1 (en)
HR (1) HRP20150320T1 (en)
HU (1) HUE026044T2 (en)
IL (2) IL186544A (en)
ME (1) ME02149B (en)
MX (1) MX2007012525A (en)
NO (1) NO20075815L (en)
PL (1) PL1885350T3 (en)
PT (1) PT1885350E (en)
RS (1) RS54050B1 (en)
SI (1) SI1885350T1 (en)
TW (1) TW200716088A (en)
WO (1) WO2007004072A2 (en)
ZA (1) ZA200709825B (en)

Families Citing this family (13)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
AU5994900A (en) * 1999-07-09 2001-01-30 Isis Innovation Limited Compounds for inhibiting diseases and preparing cells for transplantation
US20070010573A1 (en) 2003-06-23 2007-01-11 Xianqi Kong Methods and compositions for treating amyloid-related diseases
CA2900876A1 (en) 2004-12-22 2006-08-17 Bhi Limited Partnership Methods and compositions for treating amyloid-related diseases
TW200716088A (en) * 2005-04-15 2007-05-01 Neurochem Int Ltd Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis
US20070049638A1 (en) * 2005-07-21 2007-03-01 Neurochem (International) Limited Polymorphic forms of 3-amino-1-propanesulfonic acid
ATE481094T1 (en) 2005-12-22 2010-10-15 Kiacta Sarl TREATMENT OF DIABETIC NEPHROPATHY
KR101443573B1 (en) 2006-10-12 2014-11-03 비에이치아이 리미티드 파트너쉽 Methods, compounds, compositions and vehicles for delivering 3-amino-1-propanesulfonic acid
AU2007337806A1 (en) * 2006-12-22 2008-07-03 Bellus Health (International) Limited Methods, compounds, and compositions for treating metabolic disorders and diabetes
CA2768877A1 (en) * 2009-08-10 2011-02-17 Bellus Health Inc. Methods, compounds, and compositions for delivering 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid
CA2815212A1 (en) 2010-10-22 2012-04-26 Curna, Inc. Treatment of alpha-l-iduronidase (idua) related diseases by inhibition of natural antisense transcript to idua
WO2015168315A1 (en) * 2014-04-30 2015-11-05 Icahn School Of Medicine At Mount Sinai Use of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof for the treatment of sarcoidosis
WO2016023911A1 (en) * 2014-08-11 2016-02-18 Kiacta Sàrl Use of 1,3-propanedisulfonic acid or salts thereof to prevent the onset of amyloidosis in select populations
CN116143672B (en) * 2023-02-28 2024-03-29 卫星化学股份有限公司 Water-soluble antioxidant and preparation method and application thereof

Family Cites Families (94)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US2531468A (en) * 1949-04-14 1950-11-28 Eastman Kodak Co Polyvinyl sulfonates and process for their preparation
DE1122064B (en) * 1960-01-09 1962-01-18 Basf Ag Process for introducing allyphatic hydrocarbon radicals into organic compounds which contain hydroxyl groups, tertiary amino groups, aromatic sulfhydryl groups and / or aromatically bonded primary or secondary amino groups
US3218352A (en) * 1962-05-03 1965-11-16 Abbott Lab Homotaurine process
US3658966A (en) * 1969-09-15 1972-04-25 Kowa Co Methods of treating hypertension
US3920833A (en) * 1974-08-08 1975-11-18 Stanley Drug Products Inc Antifibrinolytic agents
FR2437834A1 (en) 1978-10-04 1980-04-30 Lejeune Jerome L-serine or glycine for treatment of cerebral deficiencies - such as mongolism and general mental debility, etc.
FR2457281A1 (en) * 1979-05-23 1980-12-19 Meram Lab NOVEL 3-AMINOPROPANESULFONIC ACID DERIVATIVES WITH ENHANCED MEMBRANE ACTIVITY
US4255448A (en) * 1979-09-10 1981-03-10 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation Method for reducing epileptiform activity
US4448779A (en) * 1981-07-16 1984-05-15 Sanofi Use of MS salt in geriatric medicine
JPS5879022A (en) * 1981-11-04 1983-05-12 Bitamin Kenkyusho:Kk Novel metal-crosslinked polymer compound containing quaternary nitrogen atom, its preparation, and remedy for hyperlipemia containing said polymer compound as active component
EP0119274B1 (en) 1982-09-08 1986-11-26 MITSUI TOATSU CHEMICALS, Inc. Process for producing aminoalkylsulfonic acids
US4737353A (en) * 1984-04-13 1988-04-12 Union Carbide Corporation Beryllium-aluminum-phosphorus-silicon-oxide molecular sieve compositions
IT1173990B (en) * 1984-05-16 1987-06-24 Bioresearch Spa STABLE SALTS OF SULPHO-ADENOSYL-METHIONINE (SAME) PARTICULARLY SUITABLE FOR PARENTERAL USE
JPH0733332B2 (en) * 1985-11-19 1995-04-12 富山化学工業株式会社 Dementia symptom improvement / therapeutic agent
JPH0786122B2 (en) * 1986-05-30 1995-09-20 日本ペイント株式会社 Three-dimensionally crosslinked fine resin particles and method for producing the same
US4847082A (en) * 1987-01-21 1989-07-11 Robert Sabin Method of treatment of Alzheimer's disease using phytic acid
IT1205042B (en) 1987-05-28 1989-03-10 Crinos Industria Farmaco PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITION WITH THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITIES FOR THE TREATMENT OF ALZHEIMER-TYPE OF SENILE DESENCE
IT1211792B (en) 1987-09-21 1989-11-03 Sigma Tau Ind Farmaceuti O-ALCANOIL ACID DERIVATIVES 3 AMINO 2- HYDROXYPROPANSULPHONIC ANTICONVULSIVE ADAPTITY AND THEIR PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS FOR THE THERAPEUTIC TREATMENT OF EPILEPSY
JPH01171638A (en) 1987-12-25 1989-07-06 Kanegafuchi Chem Ind Co Ltd Adsorbent for serum amyloid a protein
JP2587842B2 (en) 1987-12-09 1997-03-05 株式会社ニチレイ Neurological treatment / prevention agent
IT1212000B (en) 1987-12-24 1989-11-08 Sigma Tau Ind Farmaceuti PHENYLBENZYLIDEN-DERIVATIVES OF ACID 3) AMINOPROPANSULPHONIC WITH ANTI-CONVULSIVE ACTIVITY AND THEIR PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS FOR THE THERAPEUTIC TREATMENT OF EPILEPSY
US4968678A (en) 1988-02-19 1990-11-06 Eli Lilly And Company Tetrazole excitatory amino acid receptor antagonists
ZA891113B (en) 1988-02-19 1990-10-31 Lilly Co Eli Tetrazole excitatory amino acid receptor antagonists
JPH0627072B2 (en) 1988-09-13 1994-04-13 呉羽化学工業株式会社 In-vivo antioxidant mechanism regulator containing aminobenzoic acid derivative as active ingredient
JPH0667472B2 (en) 1988-11-28 1994-08-31 鐘淵化学工業株式会社 Adsorbent for serum amyloid P protein
US5061721A (en) 1989-03-15 1991-10-29 G. D. Searle & Co. Composition containing d-cycloserine and d-alanine for memory and learning enhancement or treatment of a cognitive or psychotic disorder
JP2761048B2 (en) 1989-08-25 1998-06-04 三共株式会社 Nerve growth factor production promoter
DE4004978A1 (en) 1990-02-19 1991-08-22 Nmi Naturwissenschaftl U Mediz Preventing therapy for Alzheimer's disease - comprises administering synthetic complexing agent with higher affinity for aluminium ions than ATP and citrate ions
JP2780846B2 (en) 1990-05-01 1998-07-30 インペリアル・ケミカル・インダストリーズ・ピーエルシー Herbicide composition
US5242932A (en) * 1991-12-17 1993-09-07 The Rockefeller University Treatment of amyloidosis associated with alzheimer disease
US5385915A (en) * 1990-05-16 1995-01-31 The Rockefeller University Treatment of amyloidosis associated with Alzheimer disease using modulators of protein phosphorylation
JPH0725786A (en) 1990-05-16 1995-01-27 Univ Rockefeller Medical treatment of amyloidosis accompanying alzheimer desease
DE4021066A1 (en) 1990-07-03 1992-01-09 Hoechst Ag LONG-TERM PROPHYLAXIS AGAINST DISEASES CAUSED BY VIRUSES OR BY UNCONVENTIONAL VIRUSES
ATE150301T1 (en) * 1990-07-19 1997-04-15 Nippon Zoki Pharmaceutical Co AMINOALKANESULPHONIC ACID DERIVATIVES AND PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS THEREOF FOR PREVENTING OR TREATING HEART DISEASES
JP2980749B2 (en) 1990-11-30 1999-11-22 協和醗酵工業株式会社 Furan derivative
US6746678B1 (en) * 1991-02-22 2004-06-08 Howard K. Shapiro Method of treating neurological diseases and etiologically related symptomology using carbonyl trapping agents in combination with medicaments
US5668117A (en) * 1991-02-22 1997-09-16 Shapiro; Howard K. Methods of treating neurological diseases and etiologically related symptomology using carbonyl trapping agents in combination with previously known medicaments
US5164295A (en) * 1991-03-06 1992-11-17 The Upjohn Company Method for identifying amyloid protein-extracellular matrix protein affinity altering compounds
US6277969B1 (en) 1991-03-18 2001-08-21 New York University Anti-TNF antibodies and peptides of human tumor necrosis factor
US5192753A (en) * 1991-04-23 1993-03-09 Mcgeer Patrick L Anti-rheumatoid arthritic drugs in the treatment of dementia
GB9117716D0 (en) 1991-08-16 1991-10-02 Lynxvale Ltd Gaba derivatives and their therapeutic application
SG47406A1 (en) * 1991-12-19 1998-04-17 Ciba Geigy Ag Aminosulfonic acid derivatives and processes for their preparation
US5318958A (en) * 1992-05-29 1994-06-07 Queen's University At Kingston Amyloid precursor protein
US5276059A (en) * 1992-07-10 1994-01-04 The United States Of America As Represented By The Department Of Health And Human Services Inhibition of diseases associated with amyloid formation
US5837672A (en) * 1992-07-10 1998-11-17 Athena Neurosciences, Inc. Methods and compositions for the detection of soluble β-amyloid peptide
US5643562A (en) * 1993-03-29 1997-07-01 Queen's University Of Kingston Method for treating amyloidosis
US5840294A (en) * 1993-03-29 1998-11-24 Queen's University At Kingston Method for treating amyloidosis
US5972328A (en) * 1993-03-29 1999-10-26 Queen's University At Kingston Method for treating amyloidosis
US20040208875A1 (en) * 1995-03-15 2004-10-21 Queen's University At Kingston Method for treating amyloidosis
JP3666818B2 (en) 1993-03-29 2005-06-29 クイーンズ ユニバーシティ アット キングストン Treatment of amyloidosis
AU7376494A (en) 1993-08-04 1995-02-28 Andrulis Pharmaceuticals Corporation Treatment of rheumatoid arthritis with thalidomide alone or in combination with other anti-inflammatory agents
US5488145A (en) * 1993-12-23 1996-01-30 Oklahoma Medical Research Foundation 2,4-disulfonyl phenyl butyl nitrone, its salts, and their use as pharmaceutical free radical traps
US5858326A (en) * 1995-06-06 1999-01-12 Neurochem, Inc. Methods of increasing amyloid deposition
AU703540B2 (en) * 1996-03-26 1999-03-25 Meddiss, Incorporated Methods for inducing analgesia or anesthesia and treating or preventing ischemic injury of tissues in general
CA2217322C (en) * 1996-10-03 2005-01-04 Coastside Bio Resources Inhibition of complement pathway by sea cucumber fractions
US6306909B1 (en) * 1997-03-12 2001-10-23 Queen's University At Kingston Anti-epileptogenic agents
US5869469A (en) * 1997-08-18 1999-02-09 Queen's University At Kingston Phosphonocarboxylate compounds for treating amyloidosis
US6294583B1 (en) * 1998-01-13 2001-09-25 Synchroneuron, Llc Methods of treating tardive dyskinesia and other movement disorders
US20020022657A1 (en) * 1998-02-11 2002-02-21 Francine Gervais Methods for modulating neuronal cell death
PT1054664E (en) * 1998-02-11 2012-11-02 Bhi Ltd Partnership Method for modulating macrophage activation
US6329356B1 (en) * 1998-04-10 2001-12-11 Neurochem, Inc. Phosphono-carboxylate compounds for treating amyloidosis
US20030147882A1 (en) * 1998-05-21 2003-08-07 Alan Solomon Methods for amyloid removal using anti-amyloid antibodies
US6310073B1 (en) * 1998-07-28 2001-10-30 Queen's University At Kingston Methods and compositions to treat glycosaminoglycan-associated molecular interactions
AU1143200A (en) * 1998-11-10 2000-05-29 Neurochem, Inc. Polymorphic forms of an amyloidosis inhibitor and methods of preparation
IL146143A0 (en) 1999-04-28 2002-07-25 Univ Kingston Compositions and methods for treating amyloidosis
US6562836B1 (en) * 1999-05-24 2003-05-13 Queen's University Of Kingston Methods and compounds for inhibiting amyloid deposits
AU5994900A (en) * 1999-07-09 2001-01-30 Isis Innovation Limited Compounds for inhibiting diseases and preparing cells for transplantation
KR20090016517A (en) * 1999-12-23 2009-02-13 벨루스 헬스 (인터내셔널) 리미티드 Compounds and methods for modulating cerebral amyloid angiopathy
US6376557B1 (en) * 2000-03-16 2002-04-23 Chanda Bhuwalka Zaveri Methods for treating alopecia
US20020115717A1 (en) * 2000-07-25 2002-08-22 Francine Gervais Amyloid targeting imaging agents and uses thereof
US7311893B2 (en) * 2000-07-25 2007-12-25 Neurochem (International) Limited Amyloid targeting imaging agents and uses thereof
US20020151506A1 (en) * 2000-12-29 2002-10-17 Castillo Gerardo M. Catechins for the treatment of fibrillogenesis in Alzheimer's disease, Parkinson's disease, systemic AA amyloidosis, and other amyloid disorders
WO2002055009A1 (en) * 2001-01-12 2002-07-18 Sun Pharmaceutical Industries Limited Spaced drug delivery system
CA2440834A1 (en) * 2001-03-13 2002-09-19 Queen's University At Kingston Anti-epileptogenic agents
US7501429B2 (en) * 2001-04-11 2009-03-10 Queen's University At Kingston Pyrimidine compounds as anti-ictogenic and/or anti-epileptogenic agents
CA2448160A1 (en) * 2001-05-25 2002-12-05 Queen's University At Kingston Heterocyclic beta-amino acids and their use as anti-epileptogenic agents
CN1658852A (en) * 2001-08-31 2005-08-24 神经化学(国际)有限公司 Amidine derivatives for treating amyloidosis
US20030077833A1 (en) * 2001-09-07 2003-04-24 Queen's University At Kingston Diagnositc methods for determining susceptibility to convulsive conditions
AU2003292936A1 (en) * 2002-12-24 2004-07-22 Neurochem (International) Limited Therapeutic formulations for the treatment of beta-amyloid related diseases
US20050031651A1 (en) * 2002-12-24 2005-02-10 Francine Gervais Therapeutic formulations for the treatment of beta-amyloid related diseases
US20050038000A1 (en) * 2003-06-23 2005-02-17 Xianqi Kong Methods and compositions for the treatment of amyloid-and epileptogenesis-associated diseases
CA2529269C (en) * 2003-06-23 2012-02-07 Neurochem (International) Limited Improved pharmaceutical drug candidates and methods for preparation thereof
US20070010573A1 (en) * 2003-06-23 2007-01-11 Xianqi Kong Methods and compositions for treating amyloid-related diseases
US7253306B2 (en) * 2003-06-23 2007-08-07 Neurochem (International) Limited Pharmaceutical drug candidates and methods for preparation thereof
US7244764B2 (en) * 2003-06-23 2007-07-17 Neurochem (International) Limited Methods and compositions for treating amyloid-related diseases
US20050142191A1 (en) * 2003-06-23 2005-06-30 Neurochem (International) Limited Pharmaceutical formulations of amyloid inhibiting compounds
US20050215562A1 (en) * 2003-06-23 2005-09-29 Patrick Tremblay Methods for treating protein aggregation disorders
US7414076B2 (en) * 2003-06-23 2008-08-19 Neurochem (International) Limited Methods and compositions for treating amyloid-related diseases
US7262223B2 (en) * 2004-01-23 2007-08-28 Neurochem (International) Limited Amidine derivatives for treating amyloidosis
WO2006008661A2 (en) * 2004-07-19 2006-01-26 Neurochem (International) Limited Diagnostic methods of multiple organ amyloidosis
MX2007005507A (en) * 2004-11-12 2008-03-13 Neurochem Int Ltd Methods and fluorinated compositions for treating amyloid-related diseases.
AU2005310979A1 (en) * 2004-11-16 2006-06-08 Bellus Health (International) Limited Compounds for the treatment of CNS and amyloid associated diseases
CA2900876A1 (en) * 2004-12-22 2006-08-17 Bhi Limited Partnership Methods and compositions for treating amyloid-related diseases
TW200716088A (en) * 2005-04-15 2007-05-01 Neurochem Int Ltd Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
AU2006264498B2 (en) 2012-09-27
ES2534553T3 (en) 2015-04-24
WO2007004072A2 (en) 2007-01-11
ES2534553T9 (en) 2015-06-25
US8178580B2 (en) 2012-05-15
CN101528216A (en) 2009-09-09
IL230935A0 (en) 2014-03-31
HRP20150320T1 (en) 2015-07-03
JP2008535906A (en) 2008-09-04
US20130296434A1 (en) 2013-11-07
KR20080003895A (en) 2008-01-08
HUE026044T2 (en) 2016-05-30
EA200702237A1 (en) 2008-06-30
PL1885350T3 (en) 2015-08-31
WO2007004072B1 (en) 2007-12-27
CN104873483A (en) 2015-09-02
EP1885350B9 (en) 2015-06-17
PT1885350E (en) 2015-04-29
SI1885350T1 (en) 2015-06-30
IL186544A0 (en) 2008-08-07
CA2582556A1 (en) 2007-01-11
HK1214158A1 (en) 2016-07-22
BRPI0610592A2 (en) 2010-07-06
EP1885350B1 (en) 2015-03-04
RS54050B1 (en) 2015-10-30
NO20075815L (en) 2008-01-11
DK1885350T3 (en) 2015-05-26
US20060252829A1 (en) 2006-11-09
TW200716088A (en) 2007-05-01
EA018898B1 (en) 2013-11-29
KR20130133915A (en) 2013-12-09
IL186544A (en) 2014-02-27
EP2944308A1 (en) 2015-11-18
ZA200709825B (en) 2009-04-29
CA2582556C (en) 2012-05-29
JP5753152B2 (en) 2015-07-22
HK1116686A1 (en) 2009-01-02
ME02149B (en) 2015-10-20
AU2006264498A1 (en) 2007-01-11
EP1885350A2 (en) 2008-02-13
MX2007012525A (en) 2007-12-06
WO2007004072A3 (en) 2007-08-23
JP2013079260A (en) 2013-05-02

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US8178580B2 (en) Formulations and methods for treating amyloidosis
Downes et al. Mechanisms of antimicrobial-induced nephrotoxicity in children
US20090286799A1 (en) Methods for the treatment of brain edema
EP3474897B1 (en) Cilastatin for use in the treatment of sepsis
JP2023541766A (en) Combination of dibotentan and dapagliflozin for the treatment of chronic kidney disease
US20140127295A1 (en) Compositions, process of preparation of said compositions and method of treating inflammatory diseases
WO2021068957A1 (en) Treatment and prevention of nephrotoxin-induced kidney injuries
US20090247498A1 (en) Pharmaceutical Compositions Primarily for the Treatment and Prevention of Genitourinary Infections and their Extragenital Complications

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION